xref: /linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision 91d2b6ee)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80  *	channel.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85  *	is not permitted.
86  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96  *	restrictions.
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113  *	on this channel.
114  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118  *	restrictions.
119  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
121  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
122  *	not permitted using this channel
123  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
124  *	not permitted using this channel
125  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
126  *	mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
127  *	even if it is otherwise disabled.
128  */
129 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD		= 1<<2,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
134 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
142 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
143 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
144 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
145 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
146 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
147 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
148 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
149 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19,
150 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20,
151 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT	= 1<<21,
152 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = 1<<22,
153 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = 1<<23,
154 	IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR	= 1<<24,
155 };
156 
157 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
158 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
159 
160 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
161 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
162 
163 /**
164  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
165  *
166  * This structure describes a single channel for use
167  * with cfg80211.
168  *
169  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
170  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
171  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
172  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
173  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
174  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
175  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
176  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
177  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
178  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
179  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
180  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
181  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
182  * @orig_mag: internal use
183  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
184  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
185  *	on this channel.
186  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
187  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
188  * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
189  */
190 struct ieee80211_channel {
191 	enum nl80211_band band;
192 	u32 center_freq;
193 	u16 freq_offset;
194 	u16 hw_value;
195 	u32 flags;
196 	int max_antenna_gain;
197 	int max_power;
198 	int max_reg_power;
199 	bool beacon_found;
200 	u32 orig_flags;
201 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
202 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
203 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
204 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
205 	s8 psd;
206 };
207 
208 /**
209  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
210  *
211  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
212  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
213  * different bands/PHY modes.
214  *
215  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
216  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
217  *	with CCK rates.
218  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
219  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
220  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
221  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
222  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
223  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
224  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
225  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
226  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
227  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
228  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
229  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
230  */
231 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
232 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
233 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
234 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
235 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
236 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
237 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
238 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
239 };
240 
241 /**
242  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
243  *
244  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
245  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
246  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
247  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
248  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
249  */
250 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
251 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
252 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
253 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
254 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
255 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
256 };
257 
258 /**
259  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
260  *
261  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
262  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
263  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
264  */
265 enum ieee80211_privacy {
266 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
267 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
268 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
269 };
270 
271 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
272 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
273 
274 /**
275  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
276  *
277  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
278  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
279  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
280  * passed around.
281  *
282  * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
283  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
284  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
285  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
286  *	short preamble is used
287  */
288 struct ieee80211_rate {
289 	u32 flags;
290 	u16 bitrate;
291 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
292 };
293 
294 /**
295  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
296  *
297  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
298  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
299  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
300  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
301  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
302  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
303  *	members of the SRG
304  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
305  *	used by members of the SRG
306  */
307 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
308 	bool enable;
309 	u8 sr_ctrl;
310 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
311 	u8 min_offset;
312 	u8 max_offset;
313 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
314 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
315 };
316 
317 /**
318  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
319  *
320  * @color: the current color.
321  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
322  * @partial: define the AID equation.
323  */
324 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
325 	u8 color;
326 	bool enabled;
327 	bool partial;
328 };
329 
330 /**
331  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
332  *
333  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
334  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
335  *
336  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
337  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
338  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
339  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
340  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
341  */
342 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
343 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
344 	bool ht_supported;
345 	u8 ampdu_factor;
346 	u8 ampdu_density;
347 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
348 };
349 
350 /**
351  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
352  *
353  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
354  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
355  *
356  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
357  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
358  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
359  */
360 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
361 	bool vht_supported;
362 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
363 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
364 };
365 
366 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
367 
368 /**
369  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
370  *
371  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
372  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
373  *
374  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
375  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
376  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
377  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
378  */
379 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
380 	bool has_he;
381 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
382 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
383 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
384 };
385 
386 /**
387  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
388  *
389  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
390  * and NSS Set field"
391  *
392  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
393  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
394  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
395  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
396  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
397  */
398 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
399 	union {
400 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
401 		struct {
402 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
403 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
404 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
405 		} __packed bw;
406 	} __packed;
407 } __packed;
408 
409 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
410 
411 /**
412  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
413  *
414  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
415  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
416  *
417  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
418  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
419  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
420  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
421  */
422 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
423 	bool has_eht;
424 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
425 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
426 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
427 };
428 
429 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
430 #ifdef __CHECKER__
431 /*
432  * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
433  * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
434  * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
435  * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
436  */
437 # define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
438 #else
439 # define __iftd
440 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
444  *
445  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
446  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
447  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
448  *
449  * @types_mask: interface types mask
450  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
451  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
452  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
453  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
454  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
455  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
456  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
457  */
458 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
459 	u16 types_mask;
460 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
461 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
462 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
463 	struct {
464 		const u8 *data;
465 		unsigned int len;
466 	} vendor_elems;
467 };
468 
469 /**
470  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
471  *
472  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
473  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
474  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
475  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
476  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
477  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
478  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
479  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
480  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
481  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
482  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
483  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
484  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
485  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
486  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
487  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
488  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
489  */
490 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
491 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
492 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
493 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
494 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
495 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
496 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
497 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
498 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
499 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
500 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
501 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
502 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
503 };
504 
505 /**
506  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
507  *
508  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
509  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
510  *
511  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
512  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
513  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
514  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
515  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
516  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
517  */
518 struct ieee80211_edmg {
519 	u8 channels;
520 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
521 };
522 
523 /**
524  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
525  *
526  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
527  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
528  *
529  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
530  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
531  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
532  */
533 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
534 	bool s1g;
535 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
536 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
537 };
538 
539 /**
540  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
541  *
542  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
543  * is able to operate in.
544  *
545  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
546  *	in this band.
547  * @band: the band this structure represents
548  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
549  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
550  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
551  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
552  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
553  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
554  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
555  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
556  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
557  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
558  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
559  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
560  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
561  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
562  *	iftype_data).
563  */
564 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
565 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
566 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
567 	enum nl80211_band band;
568 	int n_channels;
569 	int n_bitrates;
570 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
571 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
572 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
573 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
574 	u16 n_iftype_data;
575 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
576 };
577 
578 /**
579  * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
580  * @sband: the sband to initialize
581  * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
582  * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
583  *
584  * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
585  * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
586  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
587  */
588 static inline void
_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * iftd,u16 n_iftd)589 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
590 				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
591 				 u16 n_iftd)
592 {
593 	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
594 	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
595 }
596 
597 /**
598  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
599  * @sband: the sband to initialize
600  * @iftd: the iftype data array
601  */
602 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
603 	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
604 
605 /**
606  * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
607  * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
608  * @i: iterator counter
609  * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
610  */
611 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
612 	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
613 	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
614 	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
615 
616 /**
617  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
618  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
619  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
620  *
621  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
622  */
623 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)624 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
625 				u8 iftype)
626 {
627 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
628 	int i;
629 
630 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
631 		return NULL;
632 
633 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
634 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
635 
636 	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
637 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
638 			return data;
639 	}
640 
641 	return NULL;
642 }
643 
644 /**
645  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
646  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
647  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
648  *
649  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
650  */
651 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)652 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
653 			    u8 iftype)
654 {
655 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
656 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
657 
658 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
659 		return &data->he_cap;
660 
661 	return NULL;
662 }
663 
664 /**
665  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
666  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
667  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
668  *
669  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
670  */
671 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)672 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
673 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
674 {
675 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
676 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
677 
678 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
679 		return 0;
680 
681 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
682 }
683 
684 /**
685  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
686  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
687  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
688  *
689  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
690  */
691 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)692 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
693 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
694 {
695 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
696 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
697 
698 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
699 		return &data->eht_cap;
700 
701 	return NULL;
702 }
703 
704 /**
705  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
706  *
707  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
708  *
709  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
710  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
711  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
712  *
713  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
714  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
715  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
716  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
717  * without affecting other devices.
718  *
719  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
720  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
721  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
722  */
723 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
724 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
725 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)726 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
727 {
728 }
729 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
730 
731 
732 /*
733  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
734  */
735 
736 /**
737  * DOC: Actions and configuration
738  *
739  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
740  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
741  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
742  * operations use are described separately.
743  *
744  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
745  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
746  *
747  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
748  * in a separate chapter.
749  */
750 
751 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
752 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
753 
754 /**
755  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
756  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
757  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
758  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
759  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
760  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
761  *	determine the address as needed.
762  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
763  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
764  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
765  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
766  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
767  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
768  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
769  */
770 struct vif_params {
771 	u32 flags;
772 	int use_4addr;
773 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
774 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
775 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
776 };
777 
778 /**
779  * struct key_params - key information
780  *
781  * Information about a key
782  *
783  * @key: key material
784  * @key_len: length of key material
785  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
786  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
787  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
788  *	length given by @seq_len.
789  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
790  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
791  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
792  */
793 struct key_params {
794 	const u8 *key;
795 	const u8 *seq;
796 	int key_len;
797 	int seq_len;
798 	u16 vlan_id;
799 	u32 cipher;
800 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
801 };
802 
803 /**
804  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
805  * @chan: the (control) channel
806  * @width: channel width
807  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
808  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
809  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
810  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
811  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
812  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
813  *	parameters are ignored.
814  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
815  * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
816  *	bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
817  *	from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
818  */
819 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
820 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
821 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
822 	u32 center_freq1;
823 	u32 center_freq2;
824 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
825 	u16 freq1_offset;
826 	u16 punctured;
827 };
828 
829 /*
830  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
831  */
832 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
833 	struct {
834 		u32 legacy;
835 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
836 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
837 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
838 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
839 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
840 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
841 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
842 };
843 
844 
845 /**
846  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
847  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
848  *	of the peer.
849  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
850  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
851  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
852  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
853  * @retry_long: retry count value
854  * @retry_short: retry count value
855  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
856  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
857  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
858  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
859  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
860  */
861 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
862 	bool config_override;
863 	u8 tids;
864 	u64 mask;
865 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
866 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
867 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
868 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
869 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
870 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
871 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
872 };
873 
874 /**
875  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
876  * @peer: Station's MAC address
877  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
878  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
879  */
880 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
881 	const u8 *peer;
882 	u32 n_tid_conf;
883 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
884 };
885 
886 /**
887  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
888  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
889  * @kek: FILS KEK
890  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
891  * @snonce: STA Nonce
892  * @anonce: AP Nonce
893  */
894 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
895 	const u8 *macaddr;
896 	const u8 *kek;
897 	u8 kek_len;
898 	const u8 *snonce;
899 	const u8 *anonce;
900 };
901 
902 /**
903  * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
904  * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
905  *	addresses.
906  * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
907  *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
908  */
909 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
910 	const u8 *macaddr;
911 	bool enable;
912 };
913 
914 /**
915  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
916  * @chandef: the channel definition
917  *
918  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
919  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
920  */
921 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)922 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
923 {
924 	switch (chandef->width) {
925 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
926 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
927 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
928 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
929 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
930 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
931 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
932 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
933 	default:
934 		WARN_ON(1);
935 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
936 	}
937 }
938 
939 /**
940  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
941  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
942  * @channel: the control channel
943  * @chantype: the channel type
944  *
945  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
946  */
947 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
948 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
949 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
950 
951 /**
952  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
953  * @chandef1: first channel definition
954  * @chandef2: second channel definition
955  *
956  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
957  * identical, %false otherwise.
958  */
959 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)960 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
961 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
962 {
963 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
964 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
965 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
966 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
967 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
968 		chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
969 }
970 
971 /**
972  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
973  *
974  * @chandef: the channel definition
975  *
976  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
977  */
978 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)979 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
980 {
981 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
982 }
983 
984 /**
985  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
986  * @chandef1: first channel definition
987  * @chandef2: second channel definition
988  *
989  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
990  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
991  */
992 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
993 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
994 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
995 
996 /**
997  * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
998  * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
999  *
1000  * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1001  * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1002  */
1003 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1004 
1005 /**
1006  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1007  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1008  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1009  */
1010 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1011 
1012 /**
1013  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1014  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1015  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1016  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1017  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1018  */
1019 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1020 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1021 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
1022 
1023 /**
1024  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1025  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1026  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1027  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1028  * Returns:
1029  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1030  */
1031 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1032 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1033 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1034 
1035 /**
1036  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1037  *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1038  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1039  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1040  *
1041  * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1042  *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1043  */
1044 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1045 				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1046 
1047 /**
1048  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1049  *				   channel definition
1050  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1051  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1052  *
1053  * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1054  */
1055 unsigned int
1056 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1057 			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1058 
1059 /**
1060  * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1061  * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1062  * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1063  * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1064  *	according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1065  *
1066  * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1067  *	for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1068  */
1069 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1070 			     enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1071 			     u16 *punctured);
1072 
1073 /**
1074  * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1075  * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1076  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1077  *
1078  * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1079  **/
1080 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1081 
1082 /**
1083  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1084  * @width: the channel width of the channel
1085  *
1086  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1087  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1088  *
1089  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1090  */
1091 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)1092 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1093 {
1094 	switch (width) {
1095 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1096 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1097 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1098 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1099 	default:
1100 		break;
1101 	}
1102 	return 0;
1103 }
1104 
1105 /**
1106  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1107  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1108  *
1109  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1110  *
1111  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1112  */
1113 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1114 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1115 {
1116 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1117 }
1118 
1119 /**
1120  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1121  *
1122  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1123  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1124  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1125  *
1126  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1127  *
1128  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1129  */
1130 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1131 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1132 {
1133 	switch (chandef->width) {
1134 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1135 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1136 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1137 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1138 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1139 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1140 	default:
1141 		break;
1142 	}
1143 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1144 }
1145 
1146 /**
1147  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1148  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1149  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1150  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1151  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1152  *
1153  * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1154  */
1155 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1156 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1157 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1158 
1159 /**
1160  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1161  *
1162  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1163  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1164  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1165  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1166  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1167  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1168  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1169  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1170  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1171  *
1172  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1173  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1174  */
1175 enum survey_info_flags {
1176 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1177 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1178 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1179 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1180 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1181 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1182 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1183 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1184 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1185 };
1186 
1187 /**
1188  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1189  *
1190  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1191  *	record to report global statistics
1192  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1193  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1194  *	optional
1195  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1196  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1197  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1198  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1199  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1200  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1201  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1202  *
1203  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1204  *
1205  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1206  * channel duty cycle etc.
1207  */
1208 struct survey_info {
1209 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1210 	u64 time;
1211 	u64 time_busy;
1212 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1213 	u64 time_rx;
1214 	u64 time_tx;
1215 	u64 time_scan;
1216 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1217 	u32 filled;
1218 	s8 noise;
1219 };
1220 
1221 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1222 
1223 /**
1224  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1225  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1226  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1227  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1228  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1229  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1230  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1231  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1232  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1233  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1234  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1235  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1236  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1237  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1238  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1239  *	protocol frames.
1240  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1241  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1242  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1243  *	port for mac80211
1244  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1245  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1246  *	offload)
1247  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1248  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1249  *
1250  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1251  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1252  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1253  *	  such a scenario.
1254  *
1255  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1256  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1257  *
1258  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1259  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1260  *
1261  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1262  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1263  */
1264 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1265 	u32 wpa_versions;
1266 	u32 cipher_group;
1267 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1268 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1269 	int n_akm_suites;
1270 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1271 	bool control_port;
1272 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1273 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1274 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1275 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1276 	const u8 *psk;
1277 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1278 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1279 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1280 };
1281 
1282 /**
1283  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1284  *
1285  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1286  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1287  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1288  */
1289 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1290 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1291 	u8 index;
1292 	bool ema;
1293 };
1294 
1295 /**
1296  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1297  *
1298  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1299  *
1300  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1301  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1302  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1303  */
1304 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1305 	u8 cnt;
1306 	struct {
1307 		const u8 *data;
1308 		size_t len;
1309 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1310 };
1311 
1312 /**
1313  * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1314  *
1315  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1316  *
1317  * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1318  * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1319  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1320  */
1321 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1322 	u8 cnt;
1323 	struct {
1324 		const u8 *data;
1325 		size_t len;
1326 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1327 };
1328 
1329 /**
1330  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1331  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1332  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1333  *	or %NULL if not changed
1334  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1335  *	or %NULL if not changed
1336  * @head_len: length of @head
1337  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1338  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1339  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1340  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1341  *	frames or %NULL
1342  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1343  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1344  *	Response frames or %NULL
1345  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1346  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1347  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1348  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1349  * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1350  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1351  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1352  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1353  *	(measurement type 8)
1354  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1355  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1356  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1357  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1358  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1359  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1360  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1361  */
1362 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1363 	unsigned int link_id;
1364 
1365 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1366 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1367 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1368 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1369 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1370 	const u8 *lci;
1371 	const u8 *civicloc;
1372 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1373 	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1374 	s8 ftm_responder;
1375 
1376 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1377 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1378 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1379 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1380 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1381 	size_t lci_len;
1382 	size_t civicloc_len;
1383 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1384 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1385 };
1386 
1387 struct mac_address {
1388 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1389 };
1390 
1391 /**
1392  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1393  *
1394  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1395  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1396  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1397  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1398  */
1399 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1400 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1401 	int n_acl_entries;
1402 
1403 	/* Keep it last */
1404 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1405 };
1406 
1407 /**
1408  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1409  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1410  *
1411  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1412  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1413  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1414  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1415  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1416  *	frame headers.
1417  */
1418 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1419 	bool update;
1420 	u32 min_interval;
1421 	u32 max_interval;
1422 	size_t tmpl_len;
1423 	const u8 *tmpl;
1424 };
1425 
1426 /**
1427  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1428  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1429  *
1430  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1431  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1432  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1433  *	scanning
1434  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1435  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1436  */
1437 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1438 	bool update;
1439 	u32 interval;
1440 	size_t tmpl_len;
1441 	const u8 *tmpl;
1442 };
1443 
1444 /**
1445  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1446  *
1447  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1448  *
1449  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1450  * @beacon: beacon data
1451  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1452  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1453  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1454  *	user space)
1455  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1456  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1457  * @crypto: crypto settings
1458  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1459  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1460  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1461  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1462  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1463  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1464  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1465  *	MAC address based access control
1466  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1467  *	networks.
1468  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1469  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1470  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1471  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1472  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1473  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1474  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1475  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1476  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1477  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1478  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1479  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1480  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1481  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1482  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1483  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1484  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1485  */
1486 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1487 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1488 
1489 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1490 
1491 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1492 	const u8 *ssid;
1493 	size_t ssid_len;
1494 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1495 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1496 	bool privacy;
1497 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1498 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1499 	int inactivity_timeout;
1500 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1501 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1502 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1503 	bool pbss;
1504 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1505 
1506 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1507 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1508 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1509 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1510 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1511 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1512 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1513 	bool twt_responder;
1514 	u32 flags;
1515 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1516 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1517 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1518 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1519 };
1520 
1521 
1522 /**
1523  * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1524  *
1525  * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1526  *
1527  * @beacon: beacon data
1528  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1529  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1530  */
1531 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1532 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1533 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1534 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1535 };
1536 
1537 /**
1538  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1539  *
1540  * Used for channel switch
1541  *
1542  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1543  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1544  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1545  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1546  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1547  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1548  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1549  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1550  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1551  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1552  * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1553  *	MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1554  */
1555 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1556 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1557 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1558 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1559 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1560 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1561 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1562 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1563 	bool radar_required;
1564 	bool block_tx;
1565 	u8 count;
1566 	u8 link_id;
1567 };
1568 
1569 /**
1570  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1571  *
1572  * Used for bss color change
1573  *
1574  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1575  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1576  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1577  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1578  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1579  * @color: the color used after the change
1580  * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO.
1581  *	0 in case of non-MLO.
1582  */
1583 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1584 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1585 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1586 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1587 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1588 	u8 count;
1589 	u8 color;
1590 	u8 link_id;
1591 };
1592 
1593 /**
1594  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1595  *
1596  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1597  *
1598  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1599  *	to use for verification
1600  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1601  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1602  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1603  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1604  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1605  *	nl80211_iftype.
1606  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1607  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1608  *	the verification
1609  */
1610 struct iface_combination_params {
1611 	int num_different_channels;
1612 	u8 radar_detect;
1613 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1614 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1615 };
1616 
1617 /**
1618  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1619  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1620  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1621  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1622  *
1623  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1624  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1625  */
1626 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1627 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1628 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1629 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1630 };
1631 
1632 /**
1633  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1634  *
1635  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1636  *
1637  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1638  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1639  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1640  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1641  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1642  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1643  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1644  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1645  *	per peer TPC.
1646  */
1647 struct sta_txpwr {
1648 	s16 power;
1649 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1650 };
1651 
1652 /**
1653  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1654  *
1655  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1656  *
1657  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1658  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1659  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1660  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1661  *	(or NULL for no change)
1662  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1663  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1664  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1665  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1666  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1667  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1668  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1669  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1670  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1671  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1672  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1673  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1674  */
1675 struct link_station_parameters {
1676 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1677 	int link_id;
1678 	const u8 *link_mac;
1679 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1680 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1681 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1682 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1683 	u8 opmode_notif;
1684 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1685 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1686 	u8 he_capa_len;
1687 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1688 	bool txpwr_set;
1689 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1690 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1691 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1692 };
1693 
1694 /**
1695  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1696  *
1697  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1698  *
1699  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1700  * @link_id: the link id
1701  */
1702 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1703 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1704 	u32 link_id;
1705 };
1706 
1707 /**
1708  * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1709  *
1710  * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1711  *
1712  * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1713  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1714  * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1715  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1716  */
1717 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1718 	u16 dlink[8];
1719 	u16 ulink[8];
1720 };
1721 
1722 /**
1723  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1724  *
1725  * Used to change and create a new station.
1726  *
1727  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1728  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1729  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1730  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1731  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1732  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1733  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1734  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1735  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1736  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1737  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1738  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1739  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1740  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1741  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1742  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1743  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1744  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1745  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1746  *	to unknown)
1747  * @capability: station capability
1748  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1749  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1750  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1751  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1752  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1753  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1754  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1755  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1756  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1757  */
1758 struct station_parameters {
1759 	struct net_device *vlan;
1760 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1761 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1762 	int listen_interval;
1763 	u16 aid;
1764 	u16 vlan_id;
1765 	u16 peer_aid;
1766 	u8 plink_action;
1767 	u8 plink_state;
1768 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1769 	u8 max_sp;
1770 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1771 	u16 capability;
1772 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1773 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1774 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1775 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1776 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1777 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1778 	int support_p2p_ps;
1779 	u16 airtime_weight;
1780 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1781 };
1782 
1783 /**
1784  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1785  *
1786  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1787  *
1788  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1789  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1790  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1791  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1792  * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1793  *	using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1794  *	remove all stations.
1795  */
1796 struct station_del_parameters {
1797 	const u8 *mac;
1798 	u8 subtype;
1799 	u16 reason_code;
1800 	int link_id;
1801 };
1802 
1803 /**
1804  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1805  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1806  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1807  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1808  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1809  *	the AP MLME in the device
1810  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1811  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1812  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1813  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1814  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1815  *	supported/used)
1816  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1817  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1818  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1819  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1820  */
1821 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1822 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1823 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1824 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1825 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1826 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1827 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1828 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1829 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1830 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1831 };
1832 
1833 /**
1834  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1835  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1836  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1837  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1838  *
1839  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1840  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1841  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1842  *
1843  * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1844  * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1845  * use them before calling this.
1846  */
1847 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1848 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1849 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1850 
1851 /**
1852  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1853  *
1854  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1855  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1856  *
1857  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1858  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1859  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1860  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1861  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1862  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1863  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1864  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1865  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1866  */
1867 enum rate_info_flags {
1868 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1869 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1870 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1871 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1872 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1873 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1874 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1875 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1876 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1877 };
1878 
1879 /**
1880  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1881  *
1882  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1883  *
1884  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1885  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1886  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1887  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1888  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1889  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1890  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1891  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1892  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1893  * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1894  * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1895  * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1896  * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1897  * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1898  */
1899 enum rate_info_bw {
1900 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1901 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1902 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1903 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1904 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1905 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1906 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1907 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1908 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1909 	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1910 	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1911 	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1912 	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1913 	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1914 };
1915 
1916 /**
1917  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1918  *
1919  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1920  *
1921  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1922  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1923  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1924  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1925  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1926  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1927  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1928  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1929  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1930  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1931  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1932  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1933  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1934  */
1935 struct rate_info {
1936 	u16 flags;
1937 	u16 legacy;
1938 	u8 mcs;
1939 	u8 nss;
1940 	u8 bw;
1941 	u8 he_gi;
1942 	u8 he_dcm;
1943 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1944 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1945 	u8 eht_gi;
1946 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1947 };
1948 
1949 /**
1950  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1951  *
1952  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1953  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1954  *
1955  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1956  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1957  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1958  */
1959 enum bss_param_flags {
1960 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1961 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1962 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1963 };
1964 
1965 /**
1966  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1967  *
1968  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1969  *
1970  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1971  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1972  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1973  */
1974 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1975 	u8 flags;
1976 	u8 dtim_period;
1977 	u16 beacon_interval;
1978 };
1979 
1980 /**
1981  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1982  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1983  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1984  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1985  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1986  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1987  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1988  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1989  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1990  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1991  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1992  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1993  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1994  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1995  */
1996 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1997 	u32 filled;
1998 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1999 	u32 backlog_packets;
2000 	u32 flows;
2001 	u32 drops;
2002 	u32 ecn_marks;
2003 	u32 overlimit;
2004 	u32 overmemory;
2005 	u32 collisions;
2006 	u32 tx_bytes;
2007 	u32 tx_packets;
2008 	u32 max_flows;
2009 };
2010 
2011 /**
2012  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2013  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2014  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2015  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2016  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2017  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2018  *	transmitted MSDUs
2019  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2020  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2021  */
2022 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2023 	u32 filled;
2024 	u64 rx_msdu;
2025 	u64 tx_msdu;
2026 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2027 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2028 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2029 };
2030 
2031 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
2032 
2033 /**
2034  * struct station_info - station information
2035  *
2036  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2037  *
2038  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2039  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2040  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2041  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2042  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2043  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2044  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2045  * @llid: mesh local link id
2046  * @plid: mesh peer link id
2047  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2048  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2049  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2050  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2051  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2052  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2053  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2054  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2055  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2056  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2057  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2058  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2059  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2060  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2061  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2062  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2063  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2064  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2065  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2066  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2067  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2068  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2069  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2070  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2071  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2072  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2073  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2074  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2075  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2076  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2077  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2078  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2079  *	towards this station.
2080  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2081  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2082  *	from this peer
2083  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2084  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2085  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2086  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2087  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2088  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2089  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2090  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2091  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2092  *	been sent.
2093  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2094  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2095  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2096  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2097  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2098  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2099  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2100  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2101  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2102  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2103  *	dump_station() callbacks.
2104  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2105  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2106  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2107  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2108  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2109  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2110  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2111  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2112  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2113  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2114  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2115  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2116  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2117  */
2118 struct station_info {
2119 	u64 filled;
2120 	u32 connected_time;
2121 	u32 inactive_time;
2122 	u64 assoc_at;
2123 	u64 rx_bytes;
2124 	u64 tx_bytes;
2125 	u16 llid;
2126 	u16 plid;
2127 	u8 plink_state;
2128 	s8 signal;
2129 	s8 signal_avg;
2130 
2131 	u8 chains;
2132 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2133 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2134 
2135 	struct rate_info txrate;
2136 	struct rate_info rxrate;
2137 	u32 rx_packets;
2138 	u32 tx_packets;
2139 	u32 tx_retries;
2140 	u32 tx_failed;
2141 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2142 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2143 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2144 
2145 	int generation;
2146 
2147 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2148 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2149 
2150 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2151 	s64 t_offset;
2152 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2153 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2154 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2155 
2156 	u32 expected_throughput;
2157 
2158 	u64 tx_duration;
2159 	u64 rx_duration;
2160 	u64 rx_beacon;
2161 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2162 	u8 connected_to_gate;
2163 
2164 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2165 	s8 ack_signal;
2166 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2167 
2168 	u16 airtime_weight;
2169 
2170 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2171 	u32 fcs_err_count;
2172 
2173 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2174 
2175 	u8 connected_to_as;
2176 
2177 	bool mlo_params_valid;
2178 	u8 assoc_link_id;
2179 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2180 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2181 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2182 };
2183 
2184 /**
2185  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2186  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2187  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2188  */
2189 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2190 	s32 power;
2191 	u32 freq_range_index;
2192 };
2193 
2194 /**
2195  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2196  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2197  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2198  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2199  */
2200 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2201 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2202 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2203 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2204 };
2205 
2206 
2207 /**
2208  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2209  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2210  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2211  */
2212 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2213 	u32 start_freq;
2214 	u32 end_freq;
2215 };
2216 
2217 /**
2218  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2219  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2220  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2221  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2222  *
2223  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2224  * range to small ones and then append them.
2225  */
2226 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2227 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2228 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2229 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2230 };
2231 
2232 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2233 /**
2234  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2235  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2236  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2237  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2238  *
2239  * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2240  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2241  * considered undefined.
2242  */
2243 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2244 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2245 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2246 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2247 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2248 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2249 {
2250 	return -ENOENT;
2251 }
2252 #endif
2253 
2254 /**
2255  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2256  *
2257  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2258  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2259  *
2260  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2261  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2262  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2263  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2264  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2265  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2266  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2267  */
2268 enum monitor_flags {
2269 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2270 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2271 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2272 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2273 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2274 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2275 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2276 };
2277 
2278 /**
2279  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2280  *
2281  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2282  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2283  *
2284  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2285  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2286  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2287  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2288  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2289  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2290  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2291  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2292  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2293  */
2294 enum mpath_info_flags {
2295 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2296 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2297 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2298 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2299 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2300 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2301 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2302 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2303 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2304 };
2305 
2306 /**
2307  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2308  *
2309  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2310  *
2311  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2312  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2313  * @sn: target sequence number
2314  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2315  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2316  * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2317  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2318  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2319  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2320  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2321  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2322  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2323  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2324  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2325  */
2326 struct mpath_info {
2327 	u32 filled;
2328 	u32 frame_qlen;
2329 	u32 sn;
2330 	u32 metric;
2331 	u32 exptime;
2332 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2333 	u8 discovery_retries;
2334 	u8 flags;
2335 	u8 hop_count;
2336 	u32 path_change_count;
2337 
2338 	int generation;
2339 };
2340 
2341 /**
2342  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2343  *
2344  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2345  *
2346  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2347  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2348  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2349  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2350  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2351  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2352  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2353  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2354  *	(or NULL for no change)
2355  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2356  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2357  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2358  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2359  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2360  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2361  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2362  */
2363 struct bss_parameters {
2364 	int link_id;
2365 	int use_cts_prot;
2366 	int use_short_preamble;
2367 	int use_short_slot_time;
2368 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2369 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2370 	int ap_isolate;
2371 	int ht_opmode;
2372 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2373 };
2374 
2375 /**
2376  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2377  *
2378  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2379  *
2380  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2381  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2382  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2383  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2384  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2385  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2386  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2387  *	mesh interface
2388  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2389  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2390  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2391  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2392  *	elements
2393  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2394  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2395  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2396  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2397  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2398  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2399  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2400  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2401  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2402  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2403  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2404  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2405  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2406  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2407  *	element
2408  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2409  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2410  *	element
2411  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2412  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2413  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2414  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2415  *	announcements are transmitted
2416  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2417  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2418  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2419  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2420  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2421  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2422  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2423  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2424  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2425  *	station to establish a peer link
2426  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2427  *
2428  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2429  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2430  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2431  *
2432  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2433  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2434  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2435  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2436  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2437  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2438  *	setting for new peer links.
2439  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2440  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2441  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2442  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2443  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2444  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2445  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2446  *	in the mesh formation field.
2447  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2448  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2449  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2450  *      in the mesh path table
2451  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2452  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2453  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2454  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2455  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2456  */
2457 struct mesh_config {
2458 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2459 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2460 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2461 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2462 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2463 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2464 	u8 element_ttl;
2465 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2466 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2467 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2468 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2469 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2470 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2471 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2472 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2473 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2474 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2475 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2476 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2477 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2478 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2479 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2480 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2481 	u16 ht_opmode;
2482 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2483 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2484 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2485 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2486 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2487 	u32 plink_timeout;
2488 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2489 };
2490 
2491 /**
2492  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2493  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2494  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2495  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2496  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2497  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2498  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2499  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2500  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2501  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2502  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2503  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2504  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2505  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2506  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2507  * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2508  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2509  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2510  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2511  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2512  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2513  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2514  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2515  *
2516  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2517  */
2518 struct mesh_setup {
2519 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2520 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2521 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2522 	u8 sync_method;
2523 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2524 	u8 path_metric;
2525 	u8 auth_id;
2526 	const u8 *ie;
2527 	u8 ie_len;
2528 	bool is_authenticated;
2529 	bool is_secure;
2530 	bool user_mpm;
2531 	u8 dtim_period;
2532 	u16 beacon_interval;
2533 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2534 	u32 basic_rates;
2535 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2536 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2537 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2538 };
2539 
2540 /**
2541  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2542  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2543  *
2544  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2545  */
2546 struct ocb_setup {
2547 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2548 };
2549 
2550 /**
2551  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2552  * @ac: AC identifier
2553  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2554  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2555  *	1..32767]
2556  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2557  *	1..32767]
2558  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2559  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2560  */
2561 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2562 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2563 	u16 txop;
2564 	u16 cwmin;
2565 	u16 cwmax;
2566 	u8 aifs;
2567 	int link_id;
2568 };
2569 
2570 /**
2571  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2572  *
2573  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2574  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2575  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2576  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2577  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2578  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2579  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2580  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2581  * in the wiphy structure.
2582  *
2583  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2584  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2585  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2586  *
2587  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2588  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2589  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2590  * to userspace.
2591  */
2592 
2593 /**
2594  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2595  * @ssid: the SSID
2596  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2597  */
2598 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2599 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2600 	u8 ssid_len;
2601 };
2602 
2603 /**
2604  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2605  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2606  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2607  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2608  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2609  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2610  *	userspace will be notified of that
2611  */
2612 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2613 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2614 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2615 	bool aborted;
2616 };
2617 
2618 /**
2619  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2620  *
2621  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2622  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2623  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2624  *	 which the above info is relevant to
2625  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2626  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2627  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2628  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2629  * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2630  */
2631 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2632 	u32 short_ssid;
2633 	u32 channel_idx;
2634 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2635 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2636 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2637 	bool psc_no_listen;
2638 	s8 psd_20;
2639 };
2640 
2641 /**
2642  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2643  *
2644  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2645  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2646  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2647  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2648  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2649  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2650  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2651  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2652  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2653  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2654  *	%duration field.
2655  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2656  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2657  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2658  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2659  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2660  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2661  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2662  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2663  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2664  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2665  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2666  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2667  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2668  *	true if this is the second scan request
2669  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2670  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2671  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2672  * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2673  *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2674  */
2675 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2676 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2677 	int n_ssids;
2678 	u32 n_channels;
2679 	const u8 *ie;
2680 	size_t ie_len;
2681 	u16 duration;
2682 	bool duration_mandatory;
2683 	u32 flags;
2684 
2685 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2686 
2687 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2688 
2689 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2690 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2691 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2692 
2693 	/* internal */
2694 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2695 	unsigned long scan_start;
2696 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2697 	bool notified;
2698 	bool no_cck;
2699 	bool scan_6ghz;
2700 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2701 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2702 	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2703 
2704 	/* keep last */
2705 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2706 };
2707 
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2708 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2709 {
2710 	int i;
2711 
2712 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2713 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2714 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2715 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2716 	}
2717 }
2718 
2719 /**
2720  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2721  *
2722  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2723  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2724  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2725  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2726  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2727  */
2728 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2729 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2730 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2731 	s32 rssi_thold;
2732 };
2733 
2734 /**
2735  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2736  *
2737  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2738  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2739  *	infinite loop.
2740  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2741  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2742  */
2743 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2744 	u32 interval;
2745 	u32 iterations;
2746 };
2747 
2748 /**
2749  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2750  *
2751  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2752  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2753  */
2754 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2755 	enum nl80211_band band;
2756 	s8 delta;
2757 };
2758 
2759 /**
2760  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2761  *
2762  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2763  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2764  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2765  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2766  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2767  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2768  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2769  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2770  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2771  *	(others are filtered out).
2772  *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2773  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2774  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2775  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2776  * @dev: the interface
2777  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2778  * @channels: channels to scan
2779  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2780  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2781  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2782  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2783  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2784  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2785  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2786  *	index must be executed first.
2787  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2788  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2789  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2790  *	owned by a particular socket)
2791  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2792  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2793  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2794  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2795  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2796  *	supported.
2797  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2798  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2799  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2800  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2801  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2802  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2803  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2804  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2805  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2806  *	comparisons.
2807  */
2808 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2809 	u64 reqid;
2810 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2811 	int n_ssids;
2812 	u32 n_channels;
2813 	const u8 *ie;
2814 	size_t ie_len;
2815 	u32 flags;
2816 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2817 	int n_match_sets;
2818 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2819 	u32 delay;
2820 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2821 	int n_scan_plans;
2822 
2823 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2824 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2825 
2826 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2827 	s8 relative_rssi;
2828 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2829 
2830 	/* internal */
2831 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2832 	struct net_device *dev;
2833 	unsigned long scan_start;
2834 	bool report_results;
2835 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2836 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2837 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2838 	struct list_head list;
2839 
2840 	/* keep last */
2841 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2842 };
2843 
2844 /**
2845  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2846  *
2847  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2848  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2849  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2850  */
2851 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2852 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2853 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2854 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2855 };
2856 
2857 /**
2858  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2859  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2860  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2861  *	signal type
2862  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2863  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2864  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2865  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2866  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2867  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2868  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2869  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2870  *	by %parent_bssid.
2871  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2872  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2873  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2874  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2875  * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2876  *	%NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2877  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2878  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2879  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2880  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2881  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2882  * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2883  */
2884 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2885 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2886 	s32 signal;
2887 	u64 boottime_ns;
2888 	u64 parent_tsf;
2889 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2890 	u8 chains;
2891 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2892 
2893 	u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2894 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2895 
2896 	void *drv_data;
2897 };
2898 
2899 /**
2900  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2901  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2902  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2903  * @len: length of the IEs
2904  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2905  * @data: IE data
2906  */
2907 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2908 	u64 tsf;
2909 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2910 	int len;
2911 	bool from_beacon;
2912 	u8 data[];
2913 };
2914 
2915 /**
2916  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2917  *
2918  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2919  * for use in scan results and similar.
2920  *
2921  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2922  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2923  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2924  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2925  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2926  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2927  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2928  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2929  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2930  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2931  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2932  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2933  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2934  * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2935  *	cannot rely on it having valid data
2936  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2937  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2938  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2939  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2940  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2941  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2942  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2943  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2944  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2945  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2946  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2947  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2948  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2949  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2950  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2951  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2952  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2953  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2954  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2955  */
2956 struct cfg80211_bss {
2957 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2958 
2959 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2960 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2961 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2962 
2963 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2964 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2965 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2966 
2967 	s32 signal;
2968 
2969 	u16 beacon_interval;
2970 	u16 capability;
2971 
2972 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2973 	u8 chains;
2974 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2975 
2976 	u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
2977 
2978 	u8 bssid_index;
2979 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2980 
2981 	u8 use_for;
2982 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2983 
2984 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2985 };
2986 
2987 /**
2988  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2989  * @bss: the bss to search
2990  * @id: the element ID
2991  *
2992  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2993  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2994  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2995  */
2996 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2997 
2998 /**
2999  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
3000  * @bss: the bss to search
3001  * @id: the element ID
3002  *
3003  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3004  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3005  * Return: %NULL if not found.
3006  */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)3007 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3008 {
3009 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3010 }
3011 
3012 
3013 /**
3014  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3015  *
3016  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3017  * authentication.
3018  *
3019  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3020  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
3021  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3022  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3023  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3024  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3025  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3026  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3027  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3028  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3029  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3030  *	transaction sequence number field.
3031  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3032  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3033  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3034  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3035  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
3036  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3037  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3038  */
3039 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3040 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3041 	const u8 *ie;
3042 	size_t ie_len;
3043 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3044 	const u8 *key;
3045 	u8 key_len;
3046 	s8 key_idx;
3047 	const u8 *auth_data;
3048 	size_t auth_data_len;
3049 	s8 link_id;
3050 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3051 };
3052 
3053 /**
3054  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3055  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3056  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3057  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3058  * @elems_len: length of the elements
3059  * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3060  *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3061  * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3062  *	operation as a whole must fail.
3063  */
3064 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3065 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3066 	const u8 *elems;
3067 	size_t elems_len;
3068 	bool disabled;
3069 	int error;
3070 };
3071 
3072 /**
3073  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3074  *
3075  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3076  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3077  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3078  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3079  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3080  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3081  *	request (connect callback).
3082  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3083  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3084  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3085  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3086  *	flag is not set.
3087  * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3088  */
3089 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3090 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3091 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3092 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3093 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3094 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3095 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3096 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3097 	ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU			= BIT(7),
3098 };
3099 
3100 /**
3101  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3102  *
3103  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3104  * (re)association.
3105  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3106  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3107  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3108  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3109  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3110  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3111  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3112  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3113  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3114  * @crypto: crypto settings
3115  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3116  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3117  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3118  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3119  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3120  *	frame.
3121  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3122  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3123  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3124  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3125  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3126  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3127  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3128  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3129  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3130  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3131  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3132  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3133  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3134  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3135  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3136  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3137  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3138  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3139  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3140  */
3141 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3142 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3143 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3144 	size_t ie_len;
3145 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3146 	bool use_mfp;
3147 	u32 flags;
3148 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3149 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3150 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3151 	const u8 *fils_kek;
3152 	size_t fils_kek_len;
3153 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3154 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3155 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3156 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3157 	s8 link_id;
3158 };
3159 
3160 /**
3161  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3162  *
3163  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3164  * deauthentication.
3165  *
3166  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3167  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3168  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3169  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3170  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3171  *	do not set a deauth frame
3172  */
3173 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3174 	const u8 *bssid;
3175 	const u8 *ie;
3176 	size_t ie_len;
3177 	u16 reason_code;
3178 	bool local_state_change;
3179 };
3180 
3181 /**
3182  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3183  *
3184  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3185  * disassociation.
3186  *
3187  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3188  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3189  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3190  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3191  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3192  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3193  */
3194 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3195 	const u8 *ap_addr;
3196 	const u8 *ie;
3197 	size_t ie_len;
3198 	u16 reason_code;
3199 	bool local_state_change;
3200 };
3201 
3202 /**
3203  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3204  *
3205  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3206  * method.
3207  *
3208  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3209  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3210  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3211  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3212  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3213  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3214  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3215  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3216  * @ie_len: length of that
3217  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3218  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3219  *	after joining
3220  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3221  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3222  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3223  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3224  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3225  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3226  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3227  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3228  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3229  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3230  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3231  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3232  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3233  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3234  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3235  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3236  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3237  */
3238 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3239 	const u8 *ssid;
3240 	const u8 *bssid;
3241 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3242 	const u8 *ie;
3243 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3244 	u16 beacon_interval;
3245 	u32 basic_rates;
3246 	bool channel_fixed;
3247 	bool privacy;
3248 	bool control_port;
3249 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3250 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3251 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3252 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3253 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3254 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3255 	int wep_tx_key;
3256 };
3257 
3258 /**
3259  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3260  *
3261  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3262  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3263  * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3264  * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3265  */
3266 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3267 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3268 	union {
3269 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3270 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3271 	} param;
3272 };
3273 
3274 /**
3275  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3276  *
3277  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3278  * authentication and association.
3279  *
3280  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3281  *	on scan results)
3282  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3283  *	%NULL if not specified
3284  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3285  *	results)
3286  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3287  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3288  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3289  *	to use.
3290  * @ssid: SSID
3291  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3292  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3293  * @ie: IEs for association request
3294  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3295  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3296  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3297  * @crypto: crypto settings
3298  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3299  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3300  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3301  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3302  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3303  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3304  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3305  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3306  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3307  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3308  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3309  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3310  *	networks.
3311  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3312  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3313  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3314  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3315  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3316  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3317  *	frame.
3318  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3319  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3320  *	data IE.
3321  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3322  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3323  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3324  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3325  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3326  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3327  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3328  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3329  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3330  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3331  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3332  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3333  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3334  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3335  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3336  */
3337 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3338 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3339 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3340 	const u8 *bssid;
3341 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3342 	const u8 *ssid;
3343 	size_t ssid_len;
3344 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3345 	const u8 *ie;
3346 	size_t ie_len;
3347 	bool privacy;
3348 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3349 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3350 	const u8 *key;
3351 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3352 	u32 flags;
3353 	int bg_scan_period;
3354 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3355 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3356 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3357 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3358 	bool pbss;
3359 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3360 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3361 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3362 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3363 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3364 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3365 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3366 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3367 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3368 	bool want_1x;
3369 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3370 };
3371 
3372 /**
3373  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3374  *
3375  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3376  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3377  *
3378  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3379  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3380  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3381  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3382  */
3383 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3384 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3385 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3386 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3387 };
3388 
3389 /**
3390  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3391  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3392  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3393  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3394  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3395  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3396  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3397  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3398  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3399  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3400  */
3401 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3402 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
3403 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
3404 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
3405 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
3406 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
3407 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
3408 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
3409 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
3410 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
3411 };
3412 
3413 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3414 
3415 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3416 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3417 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3418 
3419 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3420 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3421 
3422 /**
3423  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3424  *
3425  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3426  * caching.
3427  *
3428  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3429  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3430  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3431  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3432  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3433  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3434  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3435  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3436  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3437  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3438  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3439  *	%NULL).
3440  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3441  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3442  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3443  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3444  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3445  *	used for it expires.
3446  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3447  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3448  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3449  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3450  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3451  */
3452 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3453 	const u8 *bssid;
3454 	const u8 *pmkid;
3455 	const u8 *pmk;
3456 	size_t pmk_len;
3457 	const u8 *ssid;
3458 	size_t ssid_len;
3459 	const u8 *cache_id;
3460 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3461 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3462 };
3463 
3464 /**
3465  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3466  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3467  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3468  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3469  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3470  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3471  *
3472  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3473  * memory, free @mask only!
3474  */
3475 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3476 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3477 	int pattern_len;
3478 	int pkt_offset;
3479 };
3480 
3481 /**
3482  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3483  *
3484  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3485  * @src: source IP address
3486  * @dst: destination IP address
3487  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3488  * @src_port: source port
3489  * @dst_port: destination port
3490  * @payload_len: data payload length
3491  * @payload: data payload buffer
3492  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3493  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3494  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3495  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3496  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3497  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3498  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3499  */
3500 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3501 	struct socket *sock;
3502 	__be32 src, dst;
3503 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3504 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3505 	int payload_len;
3506 	const u8 *payload;
3507 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3508 	u32 data_interval;
3509 	u32 wake_len;
3510 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3511 	u32 tokens_size;
3512 	/* must be last, variable member */
3513 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3514 };
3515 
3516 /**
3517  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3518  *
3519  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3520  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3521  *	operating as normal during suspend
3522  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3523  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3524  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3525  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3526  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3527  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3528  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3529  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3530  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3531  *	NULL if not configured.
3532  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3533  */
3534 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3535 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3536 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3537 	     rfkill_release;
3538 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3539 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3540 	int n_patterns;
3541 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3542 };
3543 
3544 /**
3545  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3546  *
3547  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3548  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3549  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3550  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3551  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3552  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3553  */
3554 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3555 	int delay;
3556 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3557 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3558 	int n_patterns;
3559 };
3560 
3561 /**
3562  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3563  *
3564  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3565  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3566  * @n_rules: number of rules
3567  */
3568 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3569 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3570 	int n_rules;
3571 };
3572 
3573 /**
3574  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3575  *
3576  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3577  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3578  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3579  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3580  *	occurred (in MHz)
3581  */
3582 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3583 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3584 	int n_channels;
3585 	u32 channels[];
3586 };
3587 
3588 /**
3589  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3590  *
3591  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3592  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3593  *	match information.
3594  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3595  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3596  */
3597 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3598 	int n_matches;
3599 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3600 };
3601 
3602 /**
3603  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3604  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3605  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3606  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3607  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3608  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3609  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3610  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3611  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3612  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3613  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3614  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3615  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3616  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3617  *	it is.
3618  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3619  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3620  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3621  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3622  * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3623  *	disassoc frame (in MFP).
3624  */
3625 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3626 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3627 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3628 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3629 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3630 	     unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3631 	s32 pattern_idx;
3632 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3633 	const void *packet;
3634 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3635 };
3636 
3637 /**
3638  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3639  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3640  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3641  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3642  * @kek_len: length of kek
3643  * @kck_len: length of kck
3644  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3645  */
3646 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3647 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3648 	u32 akm;
3649 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3650 };
3651 
3652 /**
3653  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3654  *
3655  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3656  *
3657  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3658  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3659  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3660  */
3661 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3662 	u16 md;
3663 	const u8 *ie;
3664 	size_t ie_len;
3665 };
3666 
3667 /**
3668  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3669  *
3670  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3671  *
3672  * @chan: channel to use
3673  * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3674  * @wait: duration for ROC
3675  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3676  * @len: buffer length
3677  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3678  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3679  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3680  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3681  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3682  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3683  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3684  */
3685 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3686 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3687 	bool offchan;
3688 	unsigned int wait;
3689 	const u8 *buf;
3690 	size_t len;
3691 	bool no_cck;
3692 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3693 	int n_csa_offsets;
3694 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3695 	int link_id;
3696 };
3697 
3698 /**
3699  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3700  *
3701  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3702  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3703  */
3704 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3705 	u8 dscp;
3706 	u8 up;
3707 };
3708 
3709 /**
3710  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3711  *
3712  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3713  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3714  */
3715 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3716 	u8 low;
3717 	u8 high;
3718 };
3719 
3720 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3721 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3722 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3723 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3724 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3725 
3726 /**
3727  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3728  *
3729  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3730  *
3731  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3732  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3733  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3734  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3735  */
3736 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3737 	u8 num_des;
3738 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3739 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3740 };
3741 
3742 /**
3743  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3744  *
3745  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3746  *
3747  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3748  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3749  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3750  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3751  */
3752 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3753 	u8 master_pref;
3754 	u8 bands;
3755 };
3756 
3757 /**
3758  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3759  * configuration
3760  *
3761  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3762  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3763  */
3764 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3765 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3766 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3767 };
3768 
3769 /**
3770  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3771  *
3772  * @filter: the content of the filter
3773  * @len: the length of the filter
3774  */
3775 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3776 	const u8 *filter;
3777 	u8 len;
3778 };
3779 
3780 /**
3781  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3782  *
3783  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3784  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3785  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3786  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3787  *	implementation specific.
3788  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3789  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3790  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3791  * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3792  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3793  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3794  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3795  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3796  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3797  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3798  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3799  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3800  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3801  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3802  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3803  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3804  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3805  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3806  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3807  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3808  */
3809 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3810 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3811 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3812 	u8 publish_type;
3813 	bool close_range;
3814 	bool publish_bcast;
3815 	bool subscribe_active;
3816 	u8 followup_id;
3817 	u8 followup_reqid;
3818 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3819 	u32 ttl;
3820 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3821 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3822 	bool srf_include;
3823 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3824 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3825 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3826 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3827 	int srf_num_macs;
3828 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3829 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3830 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3831 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3832 	u8 instance_id;
3833 	u64 cookie;
3834 };
3835 
3836 /**
3837  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3838  *
3839  * @aa: authenticator address
3840  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3841  * @pmk: the PMK material
3842  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3843  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3844  *	holds PMK-R0.
3845  */
3846 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3847 	const u8 *aa;
3848 	u8 pmk_len;
3849 	const u8 *pmk;
3850 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3851 };
3852 
3853 /**
3854  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3855  *
3856  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3857  *
3858  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3859  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3860  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3861  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3862  *	authentication response command interface.
3863  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3864  *	authentication response command interface.
3865  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3866  *	authentication request event interface.
3867  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3868  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3869  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3870  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3871  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3872  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3873  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3874  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3875  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3876  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3877  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3878  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3879  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3880  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3881  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3882  *	chosen for the authentication.
3883  */
3884 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3885 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3886 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3887 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3888 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3889 	u16 status;
3890 	const u8 *pmkid;
3891 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3892 };
3893 
3894 /**
3895  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3896  *
3897  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3898  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3899  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3900  *	answered
3901  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3902  *	successfully answered
3903  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3904  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3905  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3906  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3907  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3908  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3909  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3910  *	the responder
3911  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3912  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3913  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3914  */
3915 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3916 	u32 filled;
3917 	u32 success_num;
3918 	u32 partial_num;
3919 	u32 failed_num;
3920 	u32 asap_num;
3921 	u32 non_asap_num;
3922 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3923 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3924 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3925 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3926 };
3927 
3928 /**
3929  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3930  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3931  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3932  *	reason than just "failure"
3933  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3934  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3935  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3936  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3937  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3938  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3939  *	by the responder
3940  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3941  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3942  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3943  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3944  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3945  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3946  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3947  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3948  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3949  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3950  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3951  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3952  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3953  *	the square root of the variance)
3954  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3955  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3956  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3957  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3958  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3959  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3960  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3961  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3962  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3963  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3964  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3965  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3966  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3967  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3968  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3969  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3970  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3971  */
3972 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3973 	const u8 *lci;
3974 	const u8 *civicloc;
3975 	unsigned int lci_len;
3976 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3977 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3978 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3979 	s16 burst_index;
3980 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3981 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3982 	u8 burst_duration;
3983 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3984 	s32 rssi_avg;
3985 	s32 rssi_spread;
3986 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3987 	s64 rtt_avg;
3988 	s64 rtt_variance;
3989 	s64 rtt_spread;
3990 	s64 dist_avg;
3991 	s64 dist_variance;
3992 	s64 dist_spread;
3993 
3994 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3995 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3996 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3997 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3998 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3999 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
4000 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
4001 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
4002 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
4003 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
4004 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
4005 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
4006 };
4007 
4008 /**
4009  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4010  * @addr: address of the peer
4011  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4012  *	measurement was made)
4013  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4014  * @status: status of the measurement
4015  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4016  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
4017  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4018  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4019  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4020  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
4021  * @ftm: FTM result
4022  */
4023 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4024 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4025 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4026 
4027 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4028 
4029 	u8 final:1,
4030 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
4031 
4032 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4033 
4034 	union {
4035 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4036 	};
4037 };
4038 
4039 /**
4040  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4041  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4042  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4043  * @burst_period: burst period to use
4044  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4045  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4046  * @burst_duration: burst duration
4047  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4048  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4049  * @request_lci: request LCI information
4050  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4051  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4052  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4053  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4054  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4055  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4056  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4057  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4058  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4059  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4060  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4061  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4062  *
4063  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4064  */
4065 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4066 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4067 	u16 burst_period;
4068 	u8 requested:1,
4069 	   asap:1,
4070 	   request_lci:1,
4071 	   request_civicloc:1,
4072 	   trigger_based:1,
4073 	   non_trigger_based:1,
4074 	   lmr_feedback:1;
4075 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4076 	u8 burst_duration;
4077 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4078 	u8 ftmr_retries;
4079 	u8 bss_color;
4080 };
4081 
4082 /**
4083  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4084  * @addr: MAC address
4085  * @chandef: channel to use
4086  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4087  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4088  */
4089 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4090 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4091 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4092 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4093 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4094 };
4095 
4096 /**
4097  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4098  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4099  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4100  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4101  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4102  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4103  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4104  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4105  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4106  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4107  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4108  *	zero it means there's no timeout
4109  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4110  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4111  */
4112 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4113 	u64 cookie;
4114 	void *drv_data;
4115 	u32 n_peers;
4116 	u32 nl_portid;
4117 
4118 	u32 timeout;
4119 
4120 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4121 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4122 
4123 	struct list_head list;
4124 
4125 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4126 };
4127 
4128 /**
4129  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4130  *
4131  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4132  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4133  *
4134  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4135  *
4136  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4137  *	has to be done.
4138  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4139  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4140  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4141  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4142  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4143  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4144  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4145  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4146  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4147  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4148  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4149  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4150  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4151  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4152  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4153  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4154  */
4155 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4156 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4157 	u16 status;
4158 	const u8 *ie;
4159 	size_t ie_len;
4160 	int assoc_link_id;
4161 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4162 };
4163 
4164 /**
4165  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4166  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4167  *	for the entire device
4168  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4169  *	for the given interface
4170  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4171  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4172  *	for these subtypes
4173  */
4174 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4175 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4176 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4177 };
4178 
4179 /**
4180  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4181  *
4182  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4183  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4184  *
4185  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4186  * on success or a negative error code.
4187  *
4188  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4189  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4190  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4191  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4192  *
4193  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4194  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4195  *	configured for the device.
4196  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4197  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4198  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4199  *	the device.
4200  *
4201  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4202  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4203  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4204  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4205  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4206  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4207  *
4208  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4209  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4210  *
4211  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4212  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4213  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4214  *
4215  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4216  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4217  *	address is available.
4218  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4219  *
4220  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4221  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4222  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4223  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4224  *
4225  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4226  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4227  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4228  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4229  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4230  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4231  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4232  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4233  *
4234  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4235  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4236  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4237  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4238  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4239  *
4240  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4241  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4242  *
4243  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4244  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4245  *
4246  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4247  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4248  *
4249  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4250  *
4251  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4252  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4253  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4254  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4255  *
4256  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4257  * @del_station: Remove a station
4258  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4259  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4260  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4261  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4262  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4263  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4264  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4265  *
4266  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4267  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4268  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4269  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4270  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4271  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4272  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4273  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4274  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4275  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4276  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4277  *
4278  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4279  *
4280  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4281  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4282  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4283  *
4284  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4285  *
4286  * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4287  *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4288  *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4289  *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4290  *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4291  *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4292  *
4293  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4294  *
4295  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4296  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4297  *	join the mesh instead.
4298  *
4299  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4300  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4301  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4302  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4303  *
4304  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4305  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4306  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4307  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4308  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4309  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4310  *
4311  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4312  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4313  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4314  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4315  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4316  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4317  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4318  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4319  *
4320  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4321  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4322  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4323  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4324  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4325  *	was received.
4326  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4327  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4328  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4329  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4330  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4331  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4332  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4333  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4334  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4335  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4336  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4337  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4338  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4339  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4340  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4341  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4342  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4343  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4344  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4345  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4346  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4347  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4348  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4349  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4350  *
4351  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4352  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4353  *	to a merge.
4354  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4355  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4356  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4357  *
4358  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4359  *	MESH mode)
4360  *
4361  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4362  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4363  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4364  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4365  *
4366  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4367  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4368  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4369  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4370  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4371  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4372  *	return 0 if successful
4373  *
4374  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4375  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4376  *
4377  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4378  *
4379  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4380  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4381  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4382  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4383  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4384  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4385  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4386  *	the duration value.
4387  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4388  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4389  *	frame on another channel
4390  *
4391  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4392  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4393  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4394  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4395  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4396  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4397  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4398  *
4399  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4400  *
4401  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4402  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4403  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4404  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4405  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4406  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4407  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4408  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4409  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4410  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4411  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4412  *	disabled.)
4413  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4414  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4415  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4416  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4417  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4418  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4419  *	thresholds.
4420  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4421  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4422  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4423  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4424  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4425  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4426  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4427  *
4428  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4429  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4430  *
4431  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4432  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4433  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4434  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4435  *
4436  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4437  *
4438  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4439  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4440  *
4441  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4442  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4443  *
4444  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4445  *
4446  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4447  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4448  *	current monitoring channel.
4449  *
4450  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4451  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4452  *
4453  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4454  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4455  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4456  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4457  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4458  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4459  *
4460  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4461  *
4462  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4463  *	was finished on another phy.
4464  *
4465  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4466  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4467  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4468  *
4469  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4470  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4471  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4472  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4473  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4474  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4475  *
4476  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4477  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4478  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4479  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4480  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4481  *	as soon as possible.
4482  *
4483  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4484  *
4485  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4486  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4487  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4488  *
4489  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4490  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4491  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4492  *	account.
4493  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4494  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4495  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4496  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4497  *	rejected)
4498  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4499  *
4500  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4501  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4502  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4503  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4504  *
4505  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4506  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4507  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4508  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4509  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4510  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4511  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4512  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4513  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4514  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4515  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4516  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4517  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4518  *	provided @nan_func.
4519  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4520  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4521  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4522  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4523  *
4524  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4525  *
4526  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4527  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4528  *
4529  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4530  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4531  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4532  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4533  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4534  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4535  *
4536  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4537  *     user space
4538  *
4539  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4540  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4541  *
4542  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4543  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4544  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4545  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4546  *
4547  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4548  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4549  *	DH IE through this interface.
4550  *
4551  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4552  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4553  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4554  *	This callback may sleep.
4555  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4556  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4557  *
4558  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4559  *
4560  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4561  *
4562  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4563  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4564  *	Response frame.
4565  *
4566  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4567  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4568  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4569  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4570  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4571  *	radar channel.
4572  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4573  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4574  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4575  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4576  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4577  *
4578  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4579  * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4580  */
4581 struct cfg80211_ops {
4582 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4583 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4584 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4585 
4586 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4587 						  const char *name,
4588 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4589 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4590 						  struct vif_params *params);
4591 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4592 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4593 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4594 				       struct net_device *dev,
4595 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4596 				       struct vif_params *params);
4597 
4598 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4599 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4600 				 unsigned int link_id);
4601 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4602 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4603 				 unsigned int link_id);
4604 
4605 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4606 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4607 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4608 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4609 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4610 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4611 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4612 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4613 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4614 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4615 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4616 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4617 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4618 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4619 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4620 					u8 key_index);
4621 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4622 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4623 					  int link_id,
4624 					  u8 key_index);
4625 
4626 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4627 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4628 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4629 				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4630 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4631 			   unsigned int link_id);
4632 
4633 
4634 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4635 			       const u8 *mac,
4636 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4637 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4638 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4639 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4640 				  const u8 *mac,
4641 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4642 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4643 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4644 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4645 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4646 
4647 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4648 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4649 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4650 			       const u8 *dst);
4651 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4652 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4653 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4654 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4655 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4656 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4657 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4658 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4659 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4660 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4661 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4662 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4663 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4664 				struct net_device *dev,
4665 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4666 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4667 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4668 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4669 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4670 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4671 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4672 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4673 
4674 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4675 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4676 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4677 
4678 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4679 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4680 
4681 	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4682 			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4683 
4684 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4685 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4686 
4687 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4688 					     struct net_device *dev,
4689 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4690 
4691 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4692 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4693 
4694 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4695 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4696 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4697 
4698 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4699 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4700 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4701 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4702 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4703 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4704 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4705 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4706 
4707 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4709 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4710 					 struct net_device *dev,
4711 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4712 					 u32 changed);
4713 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4714 			      u16 reason_code);
4715 
4716 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4717 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4718 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4719 
4720 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4721 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4722 
4723 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4724 
4725 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4726 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4727 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4728 				int *dbm);
4729 
4730 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4731 
4732 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4733 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4734 				void *data, int len);
4735 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4736 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4737 				 void *data, int len);
4738 #endif
4739 
4740 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4741 				    struct net_device *dev,
4742 				    unsigned int link_id,
4743 				    const u8 *peer,
4744 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4745 
4746 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4747 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4748 
4749 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4750 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4751 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4752 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4753 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4754 
4755 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4756 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4757 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4758 				     unsigned int duration,
4759 				     u64 *cookie);
4760 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4761 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4762 					    u64 cookie);
4763 
4764 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4765 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4766 			   u64 *cookie);
4767 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4768 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4769 				       u64 cookie);
4770 
4771 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4772 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4773 
4774 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4775 				       struct net_device *dev,
4776 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4777 
4778 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4779 					     struct net_device *dev,
4780 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4781 
4782 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4783 				      struct net_device *dev,
4784 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4785 
4786 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4787 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4788 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4789 
4790 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4791 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4792 
4793 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4794 				struct net_device *dev,
4795 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4796 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4797 				   u64 reqid);
4798 
4799 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4800 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4801 
4802 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4803 			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4804 			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4805 			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4806 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4807 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4808 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4809 
4810 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4811 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4812 
4813 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4814 				  struct net_device *dev,
4815 				  u16 noack_map);
4816 
4817 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4818 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4819 			       unsigned int link_id,
4820 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4821 
4822 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4823 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4824 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4825 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4826 
4827 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4828 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4829 
4830 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4831 					 struct net_device *dev,
4832 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4833 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4834 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4835 				struct net_device *dev);
4836 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4837 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4838 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4839 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4840 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4841 				    u16 duration);
4842 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4843 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4844 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4845 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4846 
4847 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4848 				  struct net_device *dev,
4849 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4850 
4851 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4852 			       struct net_device *dev,
4853 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4854 
4855 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4856 				    unsigned int link_id,
4857 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4858 
4859 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4860 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4861 			     u16 admitted_time);
4862 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4863 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4864 
4865 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4866 				       struct net_device *dev,
4867 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4868 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4869 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4870 					      struct net_device *dev,
4871 					      const u8 *addr);
4872 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4873 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4874 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4875 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4876 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4877 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4878 			       u64 cookie);
4879 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4880 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4881 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4882 				   u32 changes);
4883 
4884 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4885 					    struct net_device *dev,
4886 					    const bool enabled);
4887 
4888 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4889 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4890 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4891 
4892 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4893 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4894 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4895 			   const u8 *aa);
4896 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4897 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4898 
4899 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4900 				   struct net_device *dev,
4901 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4902 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4903 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4904 				   u64 *cookie);
4905 
4906 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4907 				struct net_device *dev,
4908 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4909 
4910 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4911 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4912 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4913 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4914 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4915 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4916 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4917 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4918 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4919 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4920 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4921 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4922 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4923 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4924 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4925 				struct net_device *dev,
4926 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4927 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4928 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4929 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4930 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4931 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4932 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4933 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4934 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4935 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4936 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4937 	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4938 				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4939 	int	(*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4940 			    struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
4941 };
4942 
4943 /*
4944  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4945  * and registration/helper functions
4946  */
4947 
4948 /**
4949  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4950  *
4951  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4952  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
4953  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4954  *	wiphy at all
4955  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4956  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4957  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4958  *	reason to override the default
4959  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4960  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4961  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4962  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4963  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4964  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4965  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4966  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4967  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4968  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4969  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4970  *	firmware.
4971  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4972  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4973  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4974  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4975  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4976  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4977  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4978  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4979  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4980  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4981  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4982  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4983  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4984  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4985  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4986  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4987  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4988  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4989  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4990  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4991  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4992  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4993  *	should set this flag for now.
4994  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4995  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
4996  *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
4997  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
4998  *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
4999  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
5000  *	of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
5001  * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
5002  */
5003 enum wiphy_flags {
5004 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
5005 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
5006 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
5007 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
5008 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
5009 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
5010 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
5011 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
5012 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
5013 	WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT			= BIT(9),
5014 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
5015 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
5016 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= BIT(12),
5017 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
5018 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
5019 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
5020 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
5021 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
5022 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
5023 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
5024 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
5025 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
5026 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
5027 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
5028 	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
5029 	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
5030 };
5031 
5032 /**
5033  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5034  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5035  * @types: interface types (bits)
5036  */
5037 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5038 	u16 max;
5039 	u16 types;
5040 };
5041 
5042 /**
5043  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5044  *
5045  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5046  * combinations it supports concurrently.
5047  *
5048  * Examples:
5049  *
5050  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5051  *
5052  *    .. code-block:: c
5053  *
5054  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5055  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5056  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5057  *	};
5058  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5059  *		.limits = limits1,
5060  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5061  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
5062  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5063  *	};
5064  *
5065  *
5066  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5067  *
5068  *    .. code-block:: c
5069  *
5070  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5071  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5072  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5073  *	};
5074  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5075  *		.limits = limits2,
5076  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5077  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
5078  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
5079  *	};
5080  *
5081  *
5082  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5083  *
5084  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5085  *
5086  *    .. code-block:: c
5087  *
5088  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5089  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5090  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5091  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5092  *	};
5093  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5094  *		.limits = limits3,
5095  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5096  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5097  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5098  *	};
5099  *
5100  */
5101 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5102 	/**
5103 	 * @limits:
5104 	 * limits for the given interface types
5105 	 */
5106 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5107 
5108 	/**
5109 	 * @num_different_channels:
5110 	 * can use up to this many different channels
5111 	 */
5112 	u32 num_different_channels;
5113 
5114 	/**
5115 	 * @max_interfaces:
5116 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5117 	 */
5118 	u16 max_interfaces;
5119 
5120 	/**
5121 	 * @n_limits:
5122 	 * number of limitations
5123 	 */
5124 	u8 n_limits;
5125 
5126 	/**
5127 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5128 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5129 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5130 	 */
5131 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5132 
5133 	/**
5134 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5135 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5136 	 */
5137 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5138 
5139 	/**
5140 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5141 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5142 	 */
5143 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5144 
5145 	/**
5146 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5147 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5148 	 *
5149 	 * = 0
5150 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5151 	 * > 0
5152 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5153 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5154 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5155 	 */
5156 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5157 };
5158 
5159 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5160 	u16 tx, rx;
5161 };
5162 
5163 /**
5164  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5165  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5166  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5167  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5168  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5169  *	packet should be preserved in that case
5170  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5171  *	(see nl80211.h)
5172  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5173  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5174  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5175  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5176  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5177  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5178  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5179  */
5180 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5181 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5182 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5183 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5184 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5185 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5186 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5187 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5188 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5189 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5190 };
5191 
5192 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5193 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5194 	u32 data_payload_max;
5195 	u32 data_interval_max;
5196 	u32 wake_payload_max;
5197 	bool seq;
5198 };
5199 
5200 /**
5201  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5202  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5203  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5204  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5205  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5206  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5207  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5208  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5209  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5210  *	scheduled scans.
5211  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5212  *	details.
5213  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5214  */
5215 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5216 	u32 flags;
5217 	int n_patterns;
5218 	int pattern_max_len;
5219 	int pattern_min_len;
5220 	int max_pkt_offset;
5221 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5222 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5223 };
5224 
5225 /**
5226  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5227  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5228  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5229  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5230  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5231  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5232  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5233  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5234  */
5235 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5236 	int n_rules;
5237 	int max_delay;
5238 	int n_patterns;
5239 	int pattern_max_len;
5240 	int pattern_min_len;
5241 	int max_pkt_offset;
5242 };
5243 
5244 /**
5245  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5246  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5247  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5248  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5249  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5250  */
5251 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5252 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5253 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5254 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5255 };
5256 
5257 /**
5258  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5259  *
5260  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5261  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5262  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5263  *
5264  */
5265 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5266 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5267 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5268 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5269 };
5270 
5271 /**
5272  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5273  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5274  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5275  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5276  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5277  */
5278 
5279 struct sta_opmode_info {
5280 	u32 changed;
5281 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5282 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5283 	u8 rx_nss;
5284 };
5285 
5286 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5287 
5288 /**
5289  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5290  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5291  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5292  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5293  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5294  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5295  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5296  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5297  *	dumpit calls.
5298  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5299  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5300  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5301  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5302  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5303  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5304  * are used with dump requests.
5305  */
5306 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5307 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5308 	u32 flags;
5309 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5310 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5311 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5312 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5313 		      unsigned long *storage);
5314 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5315 	unsigned int maxattr;
5316 };
5317 
5318 /**
5319  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5320  * @iftype: interface type
5321  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5322  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5323  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5324  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5325  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5326  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5327  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5328  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5329  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5330  */
5331 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5332 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5333 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5334 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5335 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5336 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5337 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5338 };
5339 
5340 /**
5341  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5342  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5343  * @type: the interface type to look up
5344  *
5345  * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5346  */
5347 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5348 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5349 
5350 /**
5351  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5352  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5353  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5354  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5355  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5356  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5357  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5358  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5359  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5360  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5361  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5362  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5363  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5364  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5365  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5366  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5367  *	not limited)
5368  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5369  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5370  */
5371 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5372 	unsigned int max_peers;
5373 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5374 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5375 
5376 	struct {
5377 		u32 preambles;
5378 		u32 bandwidths;
5379 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5380 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5381 		u8 supported:1,
5382 		   asap:1,
5383 		   non_asap:1,
5384 		   request_lci:1,
5385 		   request_civicloc:1,
5386 		   trigger_based:1,
5387 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5388 	} ftm;
5389 };
5390 
5391 /**
5392  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5393  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5394  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5395  *
5396  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5397  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5398  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5399  */
5400 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5401 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5402 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5403 	int n_akm_suites;
5404 };
5405 
5406 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5407 
5408 /**
5409  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5410  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5411  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5412  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5413  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5414  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5415  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5416  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5417  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5418  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5419  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5420  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5421  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5422  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5423  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5424  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5425  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5426  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5427  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5428  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5429  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5430  *	suites are specified separately.
5431  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5432  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5433  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5434  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5435  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5436  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5437  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5438  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5439  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5440  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5441  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5442  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5443  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5444  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5445  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5446  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5447  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5448  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5449  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5450  *	unregister hardware
5451  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5452  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5453  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5454  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5455  *	(see below).
5456  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5457  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5458  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5459  *	must be set by driver
5460  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5461  *	list single interface types.
5462  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5463  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5464  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5465  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5466  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5467  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5468  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5469  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5470  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5471  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5472  *	this variable determines its size
5473  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5474  *	any given scan
5475  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5476  *	the device can run concurrently.
5477  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5478  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5479  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5480  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5481  *	supported.
5482  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5483  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5484  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5485  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5486  *	scans
5487  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5488  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5489  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5490  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5491  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5492  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5493  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5494  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5495  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5496  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5497  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5498  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5499  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5500  *
5501  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5502  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5503  *	type
5504  *
5505  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5506  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5507  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5508  *
5509  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5510  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5511  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5512  *
5513  * @probe_resp_offload:
5514  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5515  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5516  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5517  *
5518  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5519  *	may request, if implemented.
5520  *
5521  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5522  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5523  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5524  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5525  *
5526  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5527  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5528  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5529  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5530  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5531  *
5532  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5533  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5534  *
5535  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5536  *	supports for ACL.
5537  *
5538  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5539  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5540  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5541  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5542  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5543  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5544  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5545  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5546  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5547  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5548  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5549  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5550  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5551  *
5552  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5553  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5554  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5555  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5556  *
5557  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5558  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5559  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5560  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5561  *
5562  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5563  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5564  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5565  *	infinite.
5566  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5567  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5568  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5569  *
5570  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5571  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5572  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5573  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5574  *
5575  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5576  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5577  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5578  *
5579  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5580  *	wake_tx_queue
5581  *
5582  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5583  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5584  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5585  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5586  *
5587  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5588  *
5589  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5590  *	device has
5591  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5592  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5593  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5594  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5595  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5596  *	long/short retry configuration
5597  *
5598  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5599  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5600  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5601  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5602  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5603  *
5604  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5605  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5606  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5607  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5608  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5609  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5610  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5611  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5612  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5613  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5614  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5615  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5616  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5617  *
5618  * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5619  *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5620  *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5621  *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5622  *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5623  *	specify a mac address).
5624  */
5625 struct wiphy {
5626 	struct mutex mtx;
5627 
5628 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5629 
5630 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5631 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5632 
5633 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5634 
5635 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5636 
5637 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5638 	int n_iface_combinations;
5639 	u16 software_iftypes;
5640 
5641 	u16 n_addresses;
5642 
5643 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5644 	u16 interface_modes;
5645 
5646 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5647 
5648 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5649 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5650 
5651 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5652 
5653 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5654 
5655 	int bss_priv_size;
5656 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5657 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5658 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5659 	u8 max_match_sets;
5660 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5661 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5662 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5663 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5664 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5665 
5666 	int n_cipher_suites;
5667 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5668 
5669 	int n_akm_suites;
5670 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5671 
5672 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5673 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5674 
5675 	u8 retry_short;
5676 	u8 retry_long;
5677 	u32 frag_threshold;
5678 	u32 rts_threshold;
5679 	u8 coverage_class;
5680 
5681 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5682 	u32 hw_version;
5683 
5684 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5685 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5686 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5687 #endif
5688 
5689 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5690 
5691 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5692 
5693 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5694 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5695 
5696 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5697 
5698 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5699 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5700 
5701 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5702 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5703 
5704 	const void *privid;
5705 
5706 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5707 
5708 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5709 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5710 
5711 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5712 
5713 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5714 
5715 	struct device dev;
5716 
5717 	bool registered;
5718 
5719 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5720 
5721 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5722 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5723 
5724 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5725 
5726 	possible_net_t _net;
5727 
5728 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5729 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5730 #endif
5731 
5732 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5733 
5734 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5735 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5736 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5737 
5738 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5739 
5740 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5741 
5742 	u32 bss_select_support;
5743 
5744 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5745 
5746 	u32 txq_limit;
5747 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5748 	u32 txq_quantum;
5749 
5750 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5751 
5752 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5753 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5754 
5755 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5756 
5757 	struct {
5758 		u64 peer, vif;
5759 		u8 max_retry;
5760 	} tid_config_support;
5761 
5762 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5763 
5764 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5765 
5766 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5767 
5768 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5769 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5770 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5771 
5772 	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5773 
5774 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5775 };
5776 
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5777 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5778 {
5779 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5780 }
5781 
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5782 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5783 {
5784 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5785 }
5786 
5787 /**
5788  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5789  *
5790  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5791  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5792  */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5793 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5794 {
5795 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5796 	return &wiphy->priv;
5797 }
5798 
5799 /**
5800  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5801  *
5802  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5803  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5804  */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5805 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5806 {
5807 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5808 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5809 }
5810 
5811 /**
5812  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5813  *
5814  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5815  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5816  */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5817 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5818 {
5819 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5820 }
5821 
5822 /**
5823  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5824  *
5825  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5826  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5827  */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5828 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5829 {
5830 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5831 }
5832 
5833 /**
5834  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5835  *
5836  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5837  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5838  */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5839 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5840 {
5841 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5842 }
5843 
5844 /**
5845  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5846  *
5847  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5848  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5849  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5850  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5851  *
5852  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5853  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5854  *
5855  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5856  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5857  */
5858 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5859 			   const char *requested_name);
5860 
5861 /**
5862  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5863  *
5864  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5865  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5866  *
5867  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5868  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5869  *
5870  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5871  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5872  */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5873 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5874 				      int sizeof_priv)
5875 {
5876 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5877 }
5878 
5879 /**
5880  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5881  *
5882  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5883  *
5884  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5885  */
5886 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5887 
5888 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5889 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5890 
5891 /**
5892  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5893  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5894  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5895  *
5896  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5897  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5898  */
5899 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5900         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5901 
5902 /**
5903  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5904  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5905  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5906  *
5907  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5908  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5909  */
5910 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5911         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5912 
5913 /**
5914  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5915  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5916  *
5917  * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
5918  *
5919  * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
5920  */
5921 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5922 
5923 /**
5924  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5925  *
5926  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5927  *
5928  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5929  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5930  * request that is being handled.
5931  */
5932 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5933 
5934 /**
5935  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5936  *
5937  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5938  */
5939 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5940 
5941 /* internal structs */
5942 struct cfg80211_conn;
5943 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5944 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5945 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5946 
5947 /**
5948  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5949  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5950  *
5951  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5952  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5953  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5954  * differentiate which way it's called.
5955  *
5956  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5957  *
5958  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5959  *
5960  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5961  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5962  */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)5963 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5964 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5965 {
5966 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5967 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5968 }
5969 
5970 /**
5971  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5972  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5973  */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)5974 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5975 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5976 {
5977 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5978 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5979 }
5980 
5981 struct wiphy_work;
5982 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5983 
5984 struct wiphy_work {
5985 	struct list_head entry;
5986 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
5987 };
5988 
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)5989 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5990 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5991 {
5992 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5993 	work->func = func;
5994 }
5995 
5996 /**
5997  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5998  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5999  * @work: the work item
6000  *
6001  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6002  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6003  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6004  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6005  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6006  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6007  */
6008 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6009 
6010 /**
6011  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6012  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6013  * @work: the work to cancel
6014  *
6015  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6016  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6017  */
6018 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6019 
6020 /**
6021  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6022  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6023  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6024  *
6025  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6026  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6027  */
6028 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6029 
6030 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6031 	struct wiphy_work work;
6032 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6033 	struct timer_list timer;
6034 };
6035 
6036 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6037 
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)6038 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6039 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6040 {
6041 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6042 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6043 }
6044 
6045 /**
6046  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6047  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6048  * @dwork: the delayable worker
6049  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6050  *
6051  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6052  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6053  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6054  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6055  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6056  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6057  */
6058 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6059 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6060 			      unsigned long delay);
6061 
6062 /**
6063  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6064  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6065  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6066  *
6067  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6068  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6069  */
6070 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6071 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6072 
6073 /**
6074  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6075  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6076  * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6077  *
6078  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6079  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6080  */
6081 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6082 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6083 
6084 /**
6085  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6086  *
6087  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6088  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6089  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6090  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6091  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6092  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6093  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6094  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6095  *
6096  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6097  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6098  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6099  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6100  *
6101  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6102  * @iftype: interface type
6103  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6104  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6105  *	for the notifier
6106  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6107  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6108  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6109  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6110  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6111  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6112  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6113  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6114  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6115  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6116  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6117  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6118  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6119  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6120  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6121  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6122  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6123  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6124  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6125  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6126  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6127  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6128  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6129  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6130  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
6131  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6132  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6133  *	the P2P Device.
6134  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
6135  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
6136  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6137  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6138  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6139  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6140  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6141  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6142  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6143  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6144  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6145  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6146  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6147  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6148  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6149  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6150  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6151  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6152  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6153  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6154  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6155  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6156  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6157  *	unprotected beacon report
6158  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6159  *	@ap and @client for each link
6160  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6161  */
6162 struct wireless_dev {
6163 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6164 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6165 
6166 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6167 	struct list_head list;
6168 	struct net_device *netdev;
6169 
6170 	u32 identifier;
6171 
6172 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6173 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6174 
6175 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6176 
6177 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6178 
6179 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6180 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6181 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6182 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6183 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6184 
6185 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6186 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6187 
6188 	struct list_head event_list;
6189 	spinlock_t event_lock;
6190 
6191 	u8 connected:1;
6192 
6193 	bool ps;
6194 	int ps_timeout;
6195 
6196 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6197 
6198 	u32 owner_nlportid;
6199 	bool nl_owner_dead;
6200 
6201 	/* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
6202 	bool cac_started;
6203 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
6204 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6205 
6206 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6207 	/* wext data */
6208 	struct {
6209 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6210 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6211 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6212 		const u8 *ie;
6213 		size_t ie_len;
6214 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6215 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6216 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6217 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6218 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6219 	} wext;
6220 #endif
6221 
6222 	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6223 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6224 
6225 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6226 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6227 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6228 
6229 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6230 
6231 	union {
6232 		struct {
6233 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6234 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6235 			u8 ssid_len;
6236 		} client;
6237 		struct {
6238 			int beacon_interval;
6239 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6240 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6241 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6242 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6243 		} mesh;
6244 		struct {
6245 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6246 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6247 			u8 ssid_len;
6248 		} ap;
6249 		struct {
6250 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6251 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6252 			int beacon_interval;
6253 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6254 			u8 ssid_len;
6255 		} ibss;
6256 		struct {
6257 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6258 		} ocb;
6259 	} u;
6260 
6261 	struct {
6262 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6263 		union {
6264 			struct {
6265 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6266 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6267 			} ap;
6268 			struct {
6269 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6270 			} client;
6271 		};
6272 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6273 	u16 valid_links;
6274 };
6275 
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6276 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6277 {
6278 	if (wdev->netdev)
6279 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6280 	return wdev->address;
6281 }
6282 
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6283 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6284 {
6285 	if (wdev->netdev)
6286 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6287 	return wdev->is_running;
6288 }
6289 
6290 /**
6291  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6292  *
6293  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6294  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6295  */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6296 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6297 {
6298 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6299 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6300 }
6301 
6302 /**
6303  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6304  * @wdev: the wdev
6305  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6306  *
6307  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6308  */
6309 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6310 				       unsigned int link_id);
6311 
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6312 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6313 					unsigned int link_id)
6314 {
6315 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6316 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6317 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6318 }
6319 
6320 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6321 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6322 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6323 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6324 	     link_id++)						\
6325 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6326 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6327 
6328 /**
6329  * DOC: Utility functions
6330  *
6331  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6332  */
6333 
6334 /**
6335  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6336  *
6337  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6338  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6339  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6340  */
6341 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6342 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6343 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6344 {
6345 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6346 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6347 }
6348 
6349 /**
6350  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6351  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6352  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6353  */
6354 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6355 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6356 {
6357 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6358 }
6359 
6360 /**
6361  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6362  *
6363  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6364  * @chan: channel
6365  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6366  */
6367 enum nl80211_chan_width
6368 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6369 
6370 /**
6371  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6372  * @chan: channel number
6373  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6374  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6375  */
6376 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6377 
6378 /**
6379  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6380  * @chan: channel number
6381  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6382  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6383  */
6384 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6385 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6386 {
6387 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6388 }
6389 
6390 /**
6391  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6392  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6393  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6394  */
6395 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6396 
6397 /**
6398  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6399  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6400  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6401  */
6402 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6403 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6404 {
6405 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6406 }
6407 
6408 /**
6409  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6410  * frequency
6411  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6412  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6413  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6414  */
6415 struct ieee80211_channel *
6416 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6417 
6418 /**
6419  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6420  *
6421  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6422  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6423  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6424  */
6425 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6426 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6427 {
6428 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6429 }
6430 
6431 /**
6432  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6433  * @chan: control channel to check
6434  *
6435  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6436  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6437  *
6438  * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6439  */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6440 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6441 {
6442 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6443 		return false;
6444 
6445 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6446 }
6447 
6448 /**
6449  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6450  *
6451  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6452  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6453  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6454  *
6455  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6456  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6457  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6458  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6459  */
6460 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6461 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6462 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6463 
6464 /**
6465  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6466  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6467  *
6468  * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6469  * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6470  */
6471 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6472 
6473 /*
6474  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6475  *
6476  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6477  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6478  */
6479 
6480 struct radiotap_align_size {
6481 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6482 };
6483 
6484 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6485 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6486 	int n_bits;
6487 	uint32_t oui;
6488 	uint8_t subns;
6489 };
6490 
6491 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6492 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6493 	int n_ns;
6494 };
6495 
6496 /**
6497  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6498  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6499  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6500  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6501  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6502  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6503  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6504  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6505  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6506  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6507  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6508  *	radiotap namespace or not
6509  *
6510  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6511  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6512  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6513  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6514  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6515  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6516  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6517  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6518  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6519  *	next bitmap word
6520  *
6521  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6522  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6523  */
6524 
6525 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6526 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6527 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6528 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6529 
6530 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6531 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6532 
6533 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6534 	int this_arg_index;
6535 	int this_arg_size;
6536 
6537 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6538 
6539 	int _max_length;
6540 	int _arg_index;
6541 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6542 	int _reset_on_ext;
6543 };
6544 
6545 int
6546 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6547 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6548 				 int max_length,
6549 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6550 
6551 int
6552 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6553 
6554 
6555 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6556 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6557 
6558 /**
6559  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6560  *
6561  * @skb: the frame
6562  *
6563  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6564  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6565  *
6566  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6567  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6568  * 802.11 header.
6569  */
6570 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6571 
6572 /**
6573  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6574  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6575  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6576  */
6577 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6578 
6579 /**
6580  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6581  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6582  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6583  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6584  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6585  */
6586 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6587 
6588 /**
6589  * DOC: Data path helpers
6590  *
6591  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6592  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6593  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6594  */
6595 
6596 /**
6597  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6598  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6599  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6600  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6601  * @addr: the device MAC address
6602  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6603  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6604  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6605  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6606  */
6607 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6608 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6609 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6610 
6611 /**
6612  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6613  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6614  * @addr: the device MAC address
6615  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6616  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6617  */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6618 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6619 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6620 {
6621 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6622 }
6623 
6624 /**
6625  * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6626  *
6627  * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6628  * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6629  * mesh control field.
6630  *
6631  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6632  * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6633  *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6634  *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6635  *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6636  * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6637  */
6638 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6639 
6640 /**
6641  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6642  *
6643  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6644  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6645  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6646  *
6647  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6648  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6649  *	initialized by the caller.
6650  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6651  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6652  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6653  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6654  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6655  * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6656  */
6657 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6658 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6659 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6660 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6661 			      u8 mesh_control);
6662 
6663 /**
6664  * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6665  *
6666  * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6667  * protocol.
6668  *
6669  * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6670  * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6671  * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6672  */
6673 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6674 
6675 /**
6676  * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6677  *
6678  * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6679  * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6680  * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6681  *
6682  * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6683  *
6684  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6685  */
6686 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6687 
6688 /**
6689  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6690  * @skb: the data frame
6691  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6692  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6693  */
6694 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6695 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6696 
6697 /**
6698  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6699  *
6700  * @eid: element ID
6701  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6702  * @len: length of data
6703  * @match: byte array to match
6704  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6705  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6706  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6707  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6708  *	the data portion instead.
6709  *
6710  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6711  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6712  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6713  * requested element struct.
6714  *
6715  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6716  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6717  * byte array to match.
6718  */
6719 const struct element *
6720 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6721 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6722 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6723 
6724 /**
6725  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6726  *
6727  * @eid: element ID
6728  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6729  * @len: length of data
6730  * @match: byte array to match
6731  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6732  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6733  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6734  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6735  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6736  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6737  *
6738  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6739  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6740  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6741  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6742  * element ID.
6743  *
6744  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6745  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6746  * byte array to match.
6747  */
6748 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6749 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6750 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6751 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6752 {
6753 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6754 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6755 	 */
6756 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6757 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6758 		return NULL;
6759 
6760 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6761 						      match, match_len,
6762 						      match_offset ?
6763 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6764 }
6765 
6766 /**
6767  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6768  *
6769  * @eid: element ID
6770  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6771  * @len: length of data
6772  *
6773  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6774  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6775  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6776  * requested element struct.
6777  *
6778  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6779  * having to fit into the given data.
6780  */
6781 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6782 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6783 {
6784 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6785 }
6786 
6787 /**
6788  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6789  *
6790  * @eid: element ID
6791  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6792  * @len: length of data
6793  *
6794  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6795  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6796  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6797  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6798  *
6799  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6800  * having to fit into the given data.
6801  */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6802 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6803 {
6804 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6805 }
6806 
6807 /**
6808  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6809  *
6810  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6811  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6812  * @len: length of data
6813  *
6814  * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6815  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6816  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6817  * requested element struct.
6818  *
6819  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6820  * having to fit into the given data.
6821  */
6822 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6823 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6824 {
6825 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6826 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
6827 }
6828 
6829 /**
6830  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6831  *
6832  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6833  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6834  * @len: length of data
6835  *
6836  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6837  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6838  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6839  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6840  *
6841  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6842  * having to fit into the given data.
6843  */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6844 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6845 {
6846 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6847 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6848 }
6849 
6850 /**
6851  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6852  *
6853  * @oui: vendor OUI
6854  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6855  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6856  * @len: length of data
6857  *
6858  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6859  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6860  * return the element structure for the requested element.
6861  *
6862  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6863  * the given data.
6864  */
6865 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6866 						const u8 *ies,
6867 						unsigned int len);
6868 
6869 /**
6870  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6871  *
6872  * @oui: vendor OUI
6873  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6874  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6875  * @len: length of data
6876  *
6877  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6878  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6879  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6880  * element ID.
6881  *
6882  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6883  * the given data.
6884  */
6885 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)6886 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6887 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6888 {
6889 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6890 }
6891 
6892 /**
6893  * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
6894  * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
6895  * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
6896  * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
6897  */
6898 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
6899 	RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
6900 	RNR_ITER_BREAK,
6901 	RNR_ITER_ERROR,
6902 };
6903 
6904 /**
6905  * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
6906  * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
6907  *	their entries in
6908  * @elems_len: length of the elements
6909  * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
6910  *	for the return value
6911  * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
6912  * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
6913  *	or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
6914  *	%false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
6915  *	or elements were malformed.)
6916  */
6917 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
6918 		       enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
6919 		       (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
6920 			       const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
6921 			       const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
6922 		       void *iter_data);
6923 
6924 /**
6925  * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
6926  *
6927  * @elem: the element to defragment
6928  * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
6929  * @ieslen: length of @ies
6930  * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
6931  * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
6932  * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
6933  *
6934  * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
6935  *
6936  * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
6937  * skipping all headers.
6938  *
6939  * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
6940  * element in-place.
6941  */
6942 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
6943 				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
6944 				    u8 frag_id);
6945 
6946 /**
6947  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6948  *
6949  * @dev: network device
6950  * @addr: STA MAC address
6951  *
6952  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6953  * devices upon STA association.
6954  */
6955 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6956 
6957 /**
6958  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6959  *
6960  * TODO
6961  */
6962 
6963 /**
6964  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6965  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6966  *	conflicts)
6967  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6968  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6969  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6970  *	alpha2.
6971  *
6972  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6973  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6974  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6975  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6976  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6977  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6978  *
6979  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6980  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6981  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6982  *
6983  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6984  * an -ENOMEM.
6985  *
6986  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6987  */
6988 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6989 
6990 /**
6991  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6992  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6993  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6994  *
6995  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6996  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6997  * information.
6998  *
6999  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7000  */
7001 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7002 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7003 
7004 /**
7005  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7006  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7007  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7008  *
7009  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7010  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7011  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7012  *
7013  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7014  */
7015 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7016 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7017 
7018 /**
7019  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7020  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7021  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7022  *
7023  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7024  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7025  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7026  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7027  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7028  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7029  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7030  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7031  * that called this helper.
7032  */
7033 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7034 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7035 
7036 /**
7037  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7038  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7039  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7040  *
7041  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7042  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7043  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7044  * and processed already.
7045  *
7046  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7047  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7048  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7049  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7050  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7051  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7052  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7053  */
7054 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7055 					       u32 center_freq);
7056 
7057 /**
7058  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7059  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7060  *
7061  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7062  * proper string representation.
7063  *
7064  * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7065  */
7066 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7067 
7068 /**
7069  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7070  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7071  *
7072  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7073  *
7074  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7075  */
7076 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7077 
7078 /**
7079  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7080  *
7081  */
7082 
7083 /**
7084  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7085  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7086  *
7087  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7088  * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7089  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7090  *
7091  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
7092  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7093  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7094  *
7095  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7096  * an -ENODATA.
7097  *
7098  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7099  */
7100 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7101 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7102 
7103 /*
7104  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7105  * functions and BSS handling helpers
7106  */
7107 
7108 /**
7109  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7110  *
7111  * @request: the corresponding scan request
7112  * @info: information about the completed scan
7113  */
7114 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7115 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7116 
7117 /**
7118  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7119  *
7120  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7121  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7122  */
7123 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7124 
7125 /**
7126  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7127  *
7128  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7129  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7130  *
7131  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7132  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7133  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7134  */
7135 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7136 
7137 /**
7138  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7139  *
7140  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7141  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7142  *
7143  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7144  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7145  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7146  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7147  */
7148 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7149 
7150 /**
7151  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7152  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7153  * @data: the BSS metadata
7154  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7155  * @len: length of the management frame
7156  * @gfp: context flags
7157  *
7158  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7159  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7160  *
7161  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7162  * Or %NULL on error.
7163  */
7164 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7165 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7166 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7167 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7168 			       gfp_t gfp);
7169 
7170 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7171 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7172 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7173 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7174 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7175 {
7176 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7177 		.chan = rx_channel,
7178 		.signal = signal,
7179 	};
7180 
7181 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7182 }
7183 
7184 /**
7185  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7186  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7187  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7188  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7189  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7190  */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)7191 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7192 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7193 {
7194 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7195 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7196 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7197 
7198 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7199 
7200 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7201 
7202 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7203 }
7204 
7205 /**
7206  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7207  * @element: element to check
7208  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7209  *
7210  * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7211  */
7212 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7213 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7214 
7215 /**
7216  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7217  * @ie: ies
7218  * @ielen: length of IEs
7219  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7220  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7221  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7222  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7223  *
7224  * Return: the number of bytes merged
7225  */
7226 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7227 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7228 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7229 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7230 
7231 /**
7232  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7233  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7234  *	from a beacon or probe response
7235  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7236  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7237  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7238  */
7239 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7240 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7241 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7242 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7243 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7244 };
7245 
7246 /**
7247  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7248  * @ie: IEs
7249  * @ielen: length of IEs
7250  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7251  *
7252  * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7253  */
7254 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7255 				    enum nl80211_band band);
7256 
7257 /**
7258  * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7259  * @a: first SSID
7260  * @b: second SSID
7261  *
7262  * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7263  */
7264 static inline bool
cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid * a,struct cfg80211_ssid * b)7265 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7266 {
7267 	if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7268 		return false;
7269 	if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7270 		return false;
7271 	return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7272 }
7273 
7274 /**
7275  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7276  *
7277  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7278  * @data: the BSS metadata
7279  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7280  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7281  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7282  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7283  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7284  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7285  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7286  * @gfp: context flags
7287  *
7288  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7289  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7290  *
7291  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7292  * Or %NULL on error.
7293  */
7294 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7295 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7296 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7297 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7298 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7299 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7300 			 gfp_t gfp);
7301 
7302 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7303 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7304 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7305 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7306 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7307 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7308 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7309 {
7310 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7311 		.chan = rx_channel,
7312 		.signal = signal,
7313 	};
7314 
7315 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7316 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7317 					gfp);
7318 }
7319 
7320 /**
7321  * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7322  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7323  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7324  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7325  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7326  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7327  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7328  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7329  * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7330  *
7331  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7332  */
7333 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7334 					struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7335 					const u8 *bssid,
7336 					const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7337 					enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7338 					enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7339 					u32 use_for);
7340 
7341 /**
7342  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7343  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7344  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7345  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7346  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7347  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7348  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7349  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7350  *
7351  * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7352  *
7353  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7354  */
7355 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len,enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)7356 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7357 		 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7358 		 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7359 		 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7360 {
7361 	return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7362 				  bss_type, privacy,
7363 				  NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7364 }
7365 
7366 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7367 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7368 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7369 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7370 {
7371 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7372 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7373 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7374 }
7375 
7376 /**
7377  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7378  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7379  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7380  *
7381  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7382  */
7383 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7384 
7385 /**
7386  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7387  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7388  * @bss: the BSS struct
7389  *
7390  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7391  */
7392 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7393 
7394 /**
7395  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7396  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7397  * @bss: the bss to remove
7398  *
7399  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7400  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7401  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7402  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7403  */
7404 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7405 
7406 /**
7407  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7408  *
7409  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7410  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7411  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7412  *
7413  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7414  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7415  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7416  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7417  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7418  */
7419 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7420 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7421 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7422 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7423 				    void *data),
7424 		       void *iter_data);
7425 
7426 /**
7427  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7428  * @dev: network device
7429  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7430  * @len: length of the frame data
7431  *
7432  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7433  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7434  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7435  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7436  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7437  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7438  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7439  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7440  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7441  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7442  *
7443  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7444  */
7445 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7446 
7447 /**
7448  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7449  * @dev: network device
7450  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7451  *
7452  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7453  * mutex.
7454  */
7455 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7456 
7457 /**
7458  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7459  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7460  * @len: length of the frame data
7461  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7462  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7463  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7464  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7465  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7466  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7467  *	non-MLO connections
7468  * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7469  *      pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7470  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7471  *	were rejected by the AP.
7472  */
7473 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7474 	const u8 *buf;
7475 	size_t len;
7476 	const u8 *req_ies;
7477 	size_t req_ies_len;
7478 	int uapsd_queues;
7479 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7480 	struct {
7481 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7482 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7483 		u16 status;
7484 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7485 };
7486 
7487 /**
7488  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7489  * @dev: network device
7490  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7491  *
7492  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7493  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7494  *
7495  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7496  */
7497 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7498 			    const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7499 
7500 /**
7501  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7502  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7503  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7504  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7505  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7506  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7507  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7508  */
7509 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7510 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7511 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7512 	bool timeout;
7513 };
7514 
7515 /**
7516  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7517  * @dev: network device
7518  * @data: data describing the association failure
7519  *
7520  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7521  */
7522 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7523 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7524 
7525 /**
7526  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7527  * @dev: network device
7528  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7529  * @len: length of the frame data
7530  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7531  *
7532  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7533  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7534  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7535  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7536  */
7537 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7538 			   bool reconnect);
7539 
7540 /**
7541  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7542  * @dev: network device
7543  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7544  * @len: length of the frame data
7545  *
7546  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7547  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7548  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7549  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7550  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7551  *
7552  * This function may sleep.
7553  */
7554 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7555 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7556 
7557 /**
7558  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7559  * @dev: network device
7560  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7561  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7562  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7563  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7564  * @gfp: allocation flags
7565  *
7566  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7567  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7568  * primitive.
7569  */
7570 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7571 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7572 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7573 
7574 /**
7575  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7576  *
7577  * @dev: network device
7578  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7579  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7580  * @gfp: allocation flags
7581  *
7582  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7583  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7584  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7585  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7586  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7587  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7588  */
7589 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7590 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7591 
7592 /**
7593  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7594  * 					candidate
7595  *
7596  * @dev: network device
7597  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7598  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7599  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7600  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7601  * @gfp: allocation flags
7602  *
7603  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7604  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7605  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7606  */
7607 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7608 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7609 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7610 
7611 /**
7612  * DOC: RFkill integration
7613  *
7614  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7615  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7616  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7617  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7618  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7619  *
7620  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7621  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7622  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7623  */
7624 
7625 /**
7626  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7627  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7628  * @blocked: block status
7629  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7630  */
7631 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7632 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7633 
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7634 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7635 {
7636 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7637 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7638 }
7639 
7640 /**
7641  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7642  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7643  */
7644 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7645 
7646 /**
7647  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7648  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7649  */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7650 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7651 {
7652 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7653 }
7654 
7655 /**
7656  * DOC: Vendor commands
7657  *
7658  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7659  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7660  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7661  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7662  * the configuration mechanism.
7663  *
7664  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7665  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7666  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7667  *
7668  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7669  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7670  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7671  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7672  * managers etc. need.
7673  */
7674 
7675 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7676 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7677 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7678 					   int approxlen);
7679 
7680 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7681 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7682 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7683 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7684 					   unsigned int portid,
7685 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7686 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7687 
7688 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7689 
7690 /**
7691  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7692  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7693  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7694  *	be put into the skb
7695  *
7696  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7697  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7698  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7699  *
7700  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7701  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7702  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7703  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7704  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7705  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7706  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7707  *
7708  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7709  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7710  *
7711  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7712  */
7713 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7714 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7715 {
7716 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7717 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7718 }
7719 
7720 /**
7721  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7722  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7723  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7724  *
7725  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7726  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7727  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7728  * skb regardless of the return value.
7729  *
7730  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7731  */
7732 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7733 
7734 /**
7735  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7736  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7737  *
7738  * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7739  *
7740  * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7741  */
7742 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7743 
7744 /**
7745  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7746  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7747  * @wdev: the wireless device
7748  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7749  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7750  *	be put into the skb
7751  * @gfp: allocation flags
7752  *
7753  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7754  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7755  *
7756  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7757  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7758  * attribute.
7759  *
7760  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7761  * skb to send the event.
7762  *
7763  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7764  */
7765 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7766 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7767 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7768 {
7769 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7770 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7771 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7772 }
7773 
7774 /**
7775  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7776  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7777  * @wdev: the wireless device
7778  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7779  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7780  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7781  *	be put into the skb
7782  * @gfp: allocation flags
7783  *
7784  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7785  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7786  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7787  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7788  *
7789  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7790  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7791  * attribute.
7792  *
7793  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7794  * skb to send the event.
7795  *
7796  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7797  */
7798 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7799 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7800 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7801 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7802 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7803 {
7804 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7805 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7806 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7807 }
7808 
7809 /**
7810  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7811  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7812  * @gfp: allocation flags
7813  *
7814  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7815  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7816  */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7817 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7818 {
7819 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7820 }
7821 
7822 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7823 /**
7824  * DOC: Test mode
7825  *
7826  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7827  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7828  * factory programming.
7829  *
7830  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
7831  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7832  */
7833 
7834 /**
7835  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7836  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7837  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7838  *	be put into the skb
7839  *
7840  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7841  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7842  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7843  *
7844  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7845  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7846  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7847  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7848  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7849  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7850  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7851  *
7852  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7853  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7854  *
7855  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7856  */
7857 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7858 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7859 {
7860 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7861 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7862 }
7863 
7864 /**
7865  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7866  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7867  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7868  *
7869  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7870  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7871  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
7872  * regardless of the return value.
7873  *
7874  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7875  */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)7876 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7877 {
7878 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7879 }
7880 
7881 /**
7882  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7883  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7884  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7885  *	be put into the skb
7886  * @gfp: allocation flags
7887  *
7888  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7889  * testmode multicast group.
7890  *
7891  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7892  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7893  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7894  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7895  * in any other way.
7896  *
7897  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7898  * skb to send the event.
7899  *
7900  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7901  */
7902 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)7903 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7904 {
7905 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7906 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7907 					  approxlen, gfp);
7908 }
7909 
7910 /**
7911  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7912  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7913  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7914  * @gfp: allocation flags
7915  *
7916  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7917  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7918  * consumes it.
7919  */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7920 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7921 {
7922 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7923 }
7924 
7925 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7926 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
7927 #else
7928 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7929 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7930 #endif
7931 
7932 /**
7933  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7934  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7935  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7936  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7937  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7938  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7939  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7940  *	status for a FILS connection.
7941  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7942  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7943  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7944  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7945  */
7946 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7947 	const u8 *kek;
7948 	size_t kek_len;
7949 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7950 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7951 	const u8 *pmk;
7952 	size_t pmk_len;
7953 	const u8 *pmkid;
7954 };
7955 
7956 /**
7957  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7958  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7959  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7960  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7961  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7962  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7963  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7964  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7965  *	case.
7966  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7967  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7968  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7969  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7970  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7971  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7972  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7973  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7974  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7975  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7976  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7977  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7978  *	zero.
7979  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7980  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7981  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7982  *	connected AP info.
7983  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7984  *	%NULL.
7985  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7986  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7987  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7988  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7989  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7990  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7991  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7992  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7993  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7994  *	to be specified.
7995  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7996  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7997  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7998  */
7999 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
8000 	int status;
8001 	const u8 *req_ie;
8002 	size_t req_ie_len;
8003 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8004 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8005 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8006 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8007 
8008 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8009 	u16 valid_links;
8010 	struct {
8011 		const u8 *addr;
8012 		const u8 *bssid;
8013 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8014 		u16 status;
8015 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8016 };
8017 
8018 /**
8019  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8020  *
8021  * @dev: network device
8022  * @params: connection response parameters
8023  * @gfp: allocation flags
8024  *
8025  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8026  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8027  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8028  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8029  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8030  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8031  */
8032 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8033 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8034 			   gfp_t gfp);
8035 
8036 /**
8037  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8038  *
8039  * @dev: network device
8040  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8041  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8042  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8043  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8044  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8045  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8046  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8047  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8048  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8049  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8050  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8051  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8052  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8053  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8054  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8055  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8056  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8057  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8058  *	case.
8059  * @gfp: allocation flags
8060  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8061  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8062  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8063  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8064  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8065  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8066  *
8067  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8068  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8069  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8070  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8071  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8072  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8073  */
8074 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8075 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8076 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8077 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8078 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8079 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8080 {
8081 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8082 
8083 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
8084 	params.status = status;
8085 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8086 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
8087 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
8088 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8089 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8090 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8091 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8092 
8093 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
8094 }
8095 
8096 /**
8097  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8098  *
8099  * @dev: network device
8100  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8101  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8102  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8103  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8104  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8105  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8106  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8107  *	the real status code for failures.
8108  * @gfp: allocation flags
8109  *
8110  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8111  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8112  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8113  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8114  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8115  */
8116 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)8117 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8118 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8119 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8120 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8121 {
8122 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8123 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8124 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8125 }
8126 
8127 /**
8128  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8129  *
8130  * @dev: network device
8131  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8132  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8133  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8134  * @gfp: allocation flags
8135  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8136  *
8137  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8138  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8139  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8140  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8141  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8142  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8143  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8144  */
8145 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8146 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8147 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8148 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8149 {
8150 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8151 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
8152 }
8153 
8154 /**
8155  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8156  *
8157  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8158  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8159  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8160  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8161  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8162  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8163  *	Otherwise zero.
8164  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8165  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8166  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8167  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8168  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8169  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8170  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
8171  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8172  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8173  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8174  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8175  */
8176 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8177 	const u8 *req_ie;
8178 	size_t req_ie_len;
8179 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8180 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8181 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8182 
8183 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8184 	u16 valid_links;
8185 	struct {
8186 		const u8 *addr;
8187 		const u8 *bssid;
8188 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8189 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8190 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8191 };
8192 
8193 /**
8194  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8195  *
8196  * @dev: network device
8197  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8198  * @gfp: allocation flags
8199  *
8200  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8201  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8202  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8203  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8204  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8205  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8206  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8207  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8208  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8209  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8210  */
8211 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8212 		     gfp_t gfp);
8213 
8214 /**
8215  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8216  *
8217  * @dev: network device
8218  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8219  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8220  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8221  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8222  * @gfp: allocation flags
8223  *
8224  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8225  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8226  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8227  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8228  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8229  * indicate the 802.11 association.
8230  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8231  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8232  * associated STA/GC.
8233  */
8234 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8235 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8236 
8237 /**
8238  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8239  *
8240  * @dev: network device
8241  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8242  * @ie_len: length of IEs
8243  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8244  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8245  * @gfp: allocation flags
8246  *
8247  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8248  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8249  */
8250 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8251 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8252 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8253 
8254 /**
8255  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8256  * @wdev: wireless device
8257  * @cookie: the request cookie
8258  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8259  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8260  *	channel
8261  * @gfp: allocation flags
8262  */
8263 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8264 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8265 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8266 
8267 /**
8268  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8269  * @wdev: wireless device
8270  * @cookie: the request cookie
8271  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8272  * @gfp: allocation flags
8273  */
8274 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8275 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8276 					gfp_t gfp);
8277 
8278 /**
8279  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8280  * @wdev: wireless device
8281  * @cookie: the requested cookie
8282  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8283  * @gfp: allocation flags
8284  */
8285 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8286 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8287 
8288 /**
8289  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8290  *
8291  * @sinfo: the station information
8292  * @gfp: allocation flags
8293  *
8294  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8295  */
8296 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8297 
8298 /**
8299  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8300  * @sinfo: the station information
8301  *
8302  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8303  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8304  * the stack.)
8305  */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)8306 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8307 {
8308 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8309 }
8310 
8311 /**
8312  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8313  *
8314  * @dev: the netdev
8315  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8316  * @sinfo: the station information
8317  * @gfp: allocation flags
8318  */
8319 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8320 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8321 
8322 /**
8323  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8324  * @dev: the netdev
8325  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8326  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8327  * @gfp: allocation flags
8328  */
8329 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8330 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8331 
8332 /**
8333  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8334  *
8335  * @dev: the netdev
8336  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8337  * @gfp: allocation flags
8338  */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8339 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8340 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8341 {
8342 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8343 }
8344 
8345 /**
8346  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8347  *
8348  * @dev: the netdev
8349  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8350  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8351  * @gfp: allocation flags
8352  *
8353  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8354  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8355  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8356  *
8357  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8358  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8359  */
8360 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8361 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8362 			  gfp_t gfp);
8363 
8364 /**
8365  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8366  *
8367  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8368  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8369  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8370  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8371  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8372  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8373  * @len: length of the frame data
8374  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8375  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8376  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8377  */
8378 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8379 	int freq;
8380 	int sig_dbm;
8381 	bool have_link_id;
8382 	u8 link_id;
8383 	const u8 *buf;
8384 	size_t len;
8385 	u32 flags;
8386 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8387 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8388 };
8389 
8390 /**
8391  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8392  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8393  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8394  *
8395  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8396  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8397  *
8398  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8399  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8400  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8401  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8402  */
8403 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8404 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8405 
8406 /**
8407  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8408  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8409  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8410  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8411  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8412  * @len: length of the frame data
8413  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8414  *
8415  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8416  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8417  *
8418  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8419  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8420  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8421  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8422  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8423 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8424 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8425 					u32 flags)
8426 {
8427 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8428 		.freq = freq,
8429 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8430 		.buf = buf,
8431 		.len = len,
8432 		.flags = flags
8433 	};
8434 
8435 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8436 }
8437 
8438 /**
8439  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8440  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8441  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8442  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8443  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8444  * @len: length of the frame data
8445  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8446  *
8447  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8448  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8449  *
8450  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8451  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8452  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8453  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8454  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8455 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8456 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8457 				    u32 flags)
8458 {
8459 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8460 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8461 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8462 		.buf = buf,
8463 		.len = len,
8464 		.flags = flags
8465 	};
8466 
8467 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8468 }
8469 
8470 /**
8471  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8472  *
8473  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8474  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8475  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8476  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8477  * @len: length of the frame data
8478  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8479  */
8480 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8481 	u64 cookie;
8482 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8483 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8484 	const u8 *buf;
8485 	size_t len;
8486 	bool ack;
8487 };
8488 
8489 /**
8490  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8491  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8492  * @status: TX status data
8493  * @gfp: context flags
8494  *
8495  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8496  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8497  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8498  */
8499 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8500 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8501 
8502 /**
8503  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8504  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8505  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8506  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8507  * @len: length of the frame data
8508  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8509  * @gfp: context flags
8510  *
8511  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8512  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8513  * transmission attempt.
8514  */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8515 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8516 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8517 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8518 {
8519 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8520 		.cookie = cookie,
8521 		.buf = buf,
8522 		.len = len,
8523 		.ack = ack
8524 	};
8525 
8526 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8527 }
8528 
8529 /**
8530  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8531  *                                   port frames
8532  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8533  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8534  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8535  * @len: length of the frame data
8536  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8537  * @gfp: context flags
8538  *
8539  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8540  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8541  * the transmission attempt.
8542  */
8543 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8544 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8545 				     gfp_t gfp);
8546 
8547 /**
8548  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8549  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8550  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8551  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8552  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8553  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8554  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8555  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8556  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8557  *
8558  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8559  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8560  * control port frames over nl80211.
8561  *
8562  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8563  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8564  *
8565  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8566  */
8567 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8568 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8569 
8570 /**
8571  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8572  * @dev: network device
8573  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8574  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8575  * @gfp: context flags
8576  *
8577  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8578  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8579  */
8580 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8581 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8582 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8583 
8584 /**
8585  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8586  * @dev: network device
8587  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8588  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8589  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8590  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8591  * @gfp: context flags
8592  */
8593 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8594 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8595 
8596 /**
8597  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8598  * @dev: network device
8599  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8600  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8601  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8602  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8603  * @gfp: context flags
8604  *
8605  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8606  * given interval is exceeded.
8607  */
8608 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8609 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8610 
8611 /**
8612  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8613  * @dev: network device
8614  * @gfp: context flags
8615  *
8616  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8617  */
8618 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8619 
8620 /**
8621  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8622  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8623  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8624  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8625  * @gfp: context flags
8626  *
8627  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8628  */
8629 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8630 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8631 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8632 
8633 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8634 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8635 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8636 		     gfp_t gfp)
8637 {
8638 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8639 }
8640 
8641 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8642 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8643 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8644 				gfp_t gfp)
8645 {
8646 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8647 }
8648 
8649 /**
8650  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8651  * @dev: network device
8652  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8653  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8654  * @gfp: context flags
8655  *
8656  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8657  * frame.
8658  */
8659 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8660 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8661 				       gfp_t gfp);
8662 
8663 /**
8664  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8665  * @netdev: network device
8666  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8667  * @event: type of event
8668  * @gfp: context flags
8669  *
8670  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8671  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8672  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8673  */
8674 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8675 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8676 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8677 
8678 /**
8679  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8680  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8681  *
8682  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8683  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8684  */
8685 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8686 
8687 /**
8688  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8689  * @dev: network device
8690  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8691  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8692  * @gfp: allocation flags
8693  */
8694 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8695 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8696 
8697 /**
8698  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8699  * @dev: network device
8700  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8701  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8702  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8703  * @gfp: allocation flags
8704  */
8705 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8706 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8707 
8708 /**
8709  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8710  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8711  * @addr: the transmitter address
8712  * @gfp: context flags
8713  *
8714  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8715  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8716  * sender.
8717  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8718  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8719  */
8720 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8721 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8722 
8723 /**
8724  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8725  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8726  * @addr: the transmitter address
8727  * @gfp: context flags
8728  *
8729  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8730  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8731  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8732  * station to avoid event flooding.
8733  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8734  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8735  */
8736 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8737 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8738 
8739 /**
8740  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8741  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8742  * @addr: the address of the peer
8743  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8744  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8745  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8746  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8747  * @gfp: allocation flags
8748  */
8749 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8750 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8751 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8752 
8753 /**
8754  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8755  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8756  * @frame: the frame
8757  * @len: length of the frame
8758  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8759  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8760  *
8761  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8762  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8763  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8764  */
8765 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8766 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8767 
8768 /**
8769  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8770  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8771  * @frame: the frame
8772  * @len: length of the frame
8773  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8774  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8775  *
8776  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8777  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8778  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8779  */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8780 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8781 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8782 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8783 {
8784 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8785 					sig_dbm);
8786 }
8787 
8788 /**
8789  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8790  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8791  * @chandef: the channel definition
8792  * @iftype: interface type
8793  *
8794  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8795  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8796  */
8797 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8798 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8799 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8800 
8801 /**
8802  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8803  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8804  * @chandef: the channel definition
8805  * @iftype: interface type
8806  *
8807  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8808  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8809  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8810  * more permissive conditions.
8811  *
8812  * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8813  */
8814 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8815 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8816 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8817 
8818 /**
8819  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8820  * @dev: the device which switched channels
8821  * @chandef: the new channel definition
8822  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8823  *
8824  * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8825  * driver context!
8826  */
8827 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8828 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8829 			       unsigned int link_id);
8830 
8831 /**
8832  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8833  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8834  * @chandef: the future channel definition
8835  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8836  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8837  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8838  *
8839  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8840  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8841  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8842  */
8843 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8844 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8845 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8846 				       bool quiet);
8847 
8848 /**
8849  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8850  *
8851  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8852  * @band: band pointer to fill
8853  *
8854  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8855  */
8856 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8857 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
8858 
8859 /**
8860  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
8861  *
8862  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8863  * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
8864  * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
8865  *
8866  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8867  */
8868 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
8869 					  struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8870 					  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
8871 
8872 /**
8873  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8874  *
8875  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8876  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8877  *
8878  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8879  */
8880 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8881 					  u8 *op_class);
8882 
8883 /**
8884  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8885  *
8886  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8887  *
8888  * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8889  */
8890 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)8891 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8892 {
8893 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8894 }
8895 
8896 /**
8897  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8898  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8899  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8900  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8901  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8902  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8903  * @gfp: allocation flags
8904  *
8905  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8906  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8907  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8908  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8909  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8910  */
8911 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8912 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8913 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8914 
8915 /**
8916  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8917  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8918  *
8919  * Return: calculated bitrate
8920  */
8921 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8922 
8923 /**
8924  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8925  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8926  *
8927  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8928  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8929  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8930  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8931  * is unbound from the driver.
8932  *
8933  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8934  */
8935 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8936 
8937 /**
8938  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8939  * @dev: the netdev to register
8940  *
8941  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8942  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8943  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8944  * instead as well.
8945  *
8946  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8947  *
8948  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8949  */
8950 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8951 
8952 /**
8953  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8954  * @dev: the netdev to register
8955  *
8956  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8957  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8958  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8959  * usable instead as well.
8960  *
8961  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8962  */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)8963 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8964 {
8965 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
8966 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8967 #endif
8968 }
8969 
8970 /**
8971  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8972  * @ies: FT IEs
8973  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8974  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8975  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8976  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8977  */
8978 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8979 	const u8 *ies;
8980 	size_t ies_len;
8981 	const u8 *target_ap;
8982 	const u8 *ric_ies;
8983 	size_t ric_ies_len;
8984 };
8985 
8986 /**
8987  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8988  * @netdev: network device
8989  * @ft_event: IE information
8990  */
8991 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8992 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8993 
8994 /**
8995  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8996  * @ies: the input IE buffer
8997  * @len: the input length
8998  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8999  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
9000  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
9001  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
9002  *
9003  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9004  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9005  *
9006  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9007  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9008  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9009  */
9010 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9011 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9012 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9013 
9014 /**
9015  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9016  * @ies: the IE buffer
9017  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9018  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9019  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9020  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9021  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9022  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9023  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9024  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9025  *
9026  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9027  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9028  * split.
9029  *
9030  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9031  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9032  *
9033  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9034  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9035  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9036  *
9037  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9038  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9039  * used.
9040  */
9041 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9042 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9043 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9044 			      size_t offset);
9045 
9046 /**
9047  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9048  * @ies: the IE buffer
9049  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9050  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9051  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9052  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9053  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9054  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9055  *
9056  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9057  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9058  * split.
9059  *
9060  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9061  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9062  *
9063  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9064  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9065  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9066  *
9067  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9068  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9069  * used.
9070  */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)9071 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9072 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9073 {
9074 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9075 }
9076 
9077 /**
9078  * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9079  * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9080  * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9081  * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9082  *
9083  * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9084  * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9085  * accordingly.
9086  */
9087 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9088 
9089 /**
9090  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9091  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9092  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9093  * @gfp: allocation flags
9094  *
9095  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9096  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9097  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9098  * else caused the wakeup.
9099  */
9100 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9101 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9102 				   gfp_t gfp);
9103 
9104 /**
9105  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9106  *
9107  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9108  * @gfp: allocation flags
9109  *
9110  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9111  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9112  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9113  */
9114 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9115 
9116 /**
9117  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9118  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9119  *
9120  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9121  */
9122 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9123 
9124 /**
9125  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9126  *
9127  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9128  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9129  *
9130  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9131  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9132  * the interface combinations.
9133  *
9134  * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9135  */
9136 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9137 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
9138 
9139 /**
9140  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9141  *
9142  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9143  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9144  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9145  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9146  *
9147  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9148  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9149  * purposes.
9150  *
9151  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9152  */
9153 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9154 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
9155 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9156 					    void *data),
9157 			       void *data);
9158 
9159 /**
9160  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9161  *
9162  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9163  * @wdev: wireless device
9164  * @gfp: context flags
9165  *
9166  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9167  * disconnected.
9168  *
9169  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9170  */
9171 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9172 			 gfp_t gfp);
9173 
9174 /**
9175  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9176  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9177  *
9178  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9179  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9180  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9181  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9182  *
9183  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9184  * the driver while the function is running.
9185  */
9186 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9187 
9188 /**
9189  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9190  *
9191  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9192  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9193  *
9194  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9195  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9196  */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9197 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9198 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9199 {
9200 	u8 *ft_byte;
9201 
9202 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9203 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9204 }
9205 
9206 /**
9207  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9208  *
9209  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9210  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9211  *
9212  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9213  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9214  *
9215  * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9216  */
9217 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9218 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9219 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9220 {
9221 	u8 ft_byte;
9222 
9223 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9224 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9225 }
9226 
9227 /**
9228  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9229  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9230  *
9231  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9232  */
9233 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9234 
9235 /**
9236  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9237  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9238  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9239  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9240  *	 result.
9241  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9242  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9243  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9244  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9245  * @info_len: the length of the &info
9246  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9247  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9248  */
9249 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9250 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9251 	u8 inst_id;
9252 	u8 peer_inst_id;
9253 	const u8 *addr;
9254 	u8 info_len;
9255 	const u8 *info;
9256 	u64 cookie;
9257 };
9258 
9259 /**
9260  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9261  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9262  * @match: match notification parameters
9263  * @gfp: allocation flags
9264  *
9265  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9266  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9267  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9268  */
9269 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9270 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9271 
9272 /**
9273  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9274  *
9275  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9276  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9277  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9278  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9279  * @gfp: allocation flags
9280  *
9281  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9282  */
9283 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9284 				  u8 inst_id,
9285 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9286 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9287 
9288 /* ethtool helper */
9289 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9290 
9291 /**
9292  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9293  * @netdev: network device
9294  * @params: External authentication parameters
9295  * @gfp: allocation flags
9296  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9297  */
9298 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9299 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9300 				   gfp_t gfp);
9301 
9302 /**
9303  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9304  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9305  * @req: the original measurement request
9306  * @result: the result data
9307  * @gfp: allocation flags
9308  */
9309 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9310 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9311 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9312 			  gfp_t gfp);
9313 
9314 /**
9315  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9316  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9317  * @req: the original measurement request
9318  * @gfp: allocation flags
9319  *
9320  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9321  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9322  */
9323 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9324 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9325 			    gfp_t gfp);
9326 
9327 /**
9328  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9329  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9330  * @iftype: interface type
9331  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9332  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9333  *
9334  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9335  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9336  * check_swif is '1'.
9337  *
9338  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9339  */
9340 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9341 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9342 
9343 
9344 /**
9345  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9346  * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9347  * @netdev: network device
9348  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9349  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9350  *
9351  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9352  */
9353 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9354 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9355 
9356 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9357 
9358 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9359 
9360 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9361 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9362 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9363 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9364 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9365 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9366 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9367 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9368 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9369 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9370 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9371 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9372 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9373 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9374 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9375 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9376 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9377 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9378 
9379 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9380 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9381 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9382 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9383 
9384 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9385 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9386 
9387 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9388 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9389 
9390 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9391 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9392 #else
9393 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9394 ({									\
9395 	if (0)								\
9396 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9397 	0;								\
9398 })
9399 #endif
9400 
9401 /*
9402  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9403  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9404  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9405  */
9406 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9407 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9408 
9409 /**
9410  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9411  * @netdev: network device
9412  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9413  * @gfp: allocation flags
9414  */
9415 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9416 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9417 				    gfp_t gfp);
9418 
9419 /**
9420  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9421  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9422  */
9423 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9424 
9425 /**
9426  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9427  * @dev: network device
9428  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9429  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9430  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9431  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9432  *
9433  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9434  */
9435 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9436 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9437 			      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
9438 
9439 /**
9440  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9441  * @dev: network device
9442  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9443  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9444  *
9445  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9446  */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,u8 link_id)9447 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9448 						       u64 color_bitmap,
9449 						       u8 link_id)
9450 {
9451 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9452 					 0, color_bitmap, link_id);
9453 }
9454 
9455 /**
9456  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9457  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9458  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9459  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9460  *
9461  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9462  *
9463  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9464  */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count,u8 link_id)9465 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9466 						       u8 count, u8 link_id)
9467 {
9468 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9469 					 count, 0, link_id);
9470 }
9471 
9472 /**
9473  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9474  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9475  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9476  *
9477  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9478  *
9479  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9480  */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9481 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9482 						       u8 link_id)
9483 {
9484 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9485 					 0, 0, link_id);
9486 }
9487 
9488 /**
9489  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9490  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9491  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9492  *
9493  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9494  *
9495  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9496  */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9497 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9498 					       u8 link_id)
9499 {
9500 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9501 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9502 					 0, 0, link_id);
9503 }
9504 
9505 /**
9506  * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9507  * @dev: network device.
9508  * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9509  *
9510  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9511  * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9512  * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9513  * case disconnect instead.
9514  * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9515  */
9516 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9517 
9518 /**
9519  * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9520  * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9521  *
9522  * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9523  * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9524  * hold anymore.
9525  */
9526 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9527 
9528 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9529 /**
9530  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9531  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9532  * @file: the file being read
9533  * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9534  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9535  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9536  * @count: read count
9537  * @ppos: read position
9538  * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9539  * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9540  *
9541  * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9542  */
9543 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9544 				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9545 				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9546 				  loff_t *ppos,
9547 				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9548 						     struct file *file,
9549 						     char *buf,
9550 						     size_t bufsize,
9551 						     void *data),
9552 				  void *data);
9553 
9554 /**
9555  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9556  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9557  * @file: the file being written to
9558  * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9559  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9560  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9561  * @count: read count
9562  * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9563  * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9564  *
9565  * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9566  */
9567 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9568 				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9569 				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9570 				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9571 						      struct file *file,
9572 						      char *buf,
9573 						      size_t count,
9574 						      void *data),
9575 				   void *data);
9576 #endif
9577 
9578 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9579